4 @setfilename ../../info/org
5 @settitle The Org Manual
8 @set DATE December 2010
10 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
11 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
12 @set txicodequoteundirected
13 @set txicodequotebacktick
15 @c Version and Contact Info
16 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
17 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
18 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
19 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
20 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
25 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
27 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
28 @c =======================================
30 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
31 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
35 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
37 @c orgkey{key} A key item
38 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
39 @c xorgcmd{key,cmmand} Key with command name as @itemx
40 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
41 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
42 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
43 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
44 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
45 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
46 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
47 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
49 @c a key but no command
61 @c one key with a command
62 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
63 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
71 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
80 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
81 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
82 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
90 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
99 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
100 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
101 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
108 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
116 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
117 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
118 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
126 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
135 @c two keys with one command
136 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
137 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
146 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
152 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
156 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
158 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
159 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
160 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
167 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
171 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
182 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
183 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
184 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
193 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
199 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
203 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
204 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
205 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
214 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
220 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
224 @c two keys with two commands
225 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
226 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
227 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
234 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
235 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
238 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
239 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
249 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
252 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
255 @c Subheadings inside a table.
256 @macro tsubheading{text}
258 @subsubheading \text\
266 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
268 Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
269 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
272 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
273 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
274 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
275 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
276 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
277 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
279 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
280 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
281 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
283 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
284 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
285 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
286 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
292 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
296 @title The Org Manual
298 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
299 @author by Carsten Dominik
300 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, and Thomas Dye
302 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
304 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
308 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
312 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
319 * Introduction:: Getting started
320 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
321 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
322 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
323 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
324 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
325 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
326 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
327 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
328 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
329 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
330 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
331 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
332 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
333 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
334 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
335 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
336 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
337 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
338 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
339 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
340 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
343 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
347 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
348 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
349 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
350 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
351 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
355 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
356 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
357 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
358 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
359 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
360 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
361 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
362 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
363 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
364 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
365 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
369 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
370 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
371 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
372 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
373 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
374 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
378 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
379 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
380 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
381 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
382 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
383 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
384 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
385 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
389 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
390 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
391 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
392 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
393 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
394 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
395 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
396 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
400 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
404 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
405 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
406 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
407 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
408 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
409 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
411 Extended use of TODO keywords
413 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
414 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
415 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
416 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
417 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
418 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
419 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
423 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
424 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
425 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
429 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
430 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
431 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
433 Properties and columns
435 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
436 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
437 * Property searches:: Matching property values
438 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
439 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
440 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
444 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
445 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
446 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
450 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
451 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
455 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
456 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
457 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
458 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
459 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
460 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
461 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
465 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
466 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
468 Deadlines and scheduling
470 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
471 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
475 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
476 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
477 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
479 Capture - Refile - Archive
481 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
482 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
483 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
484 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
485 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
486 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
490 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
491 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
492 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
496 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
497 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
501 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
502 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
506 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
507 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
508 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
509 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
510 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
511 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
512 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
513 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
515 The built-in agenda views
517 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
518 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
519 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
520 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
521 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
522 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
524 Presentation and sorting
526 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
527 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
528 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
532 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
533 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
534 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
536 Markup for rich export
538 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
539 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
540 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
541 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
542 * Index entries:: Making an index
543 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
544 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
546 Structural markup elements
548 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
549 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
550 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
551 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
553 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
554 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
555 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
556 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
557 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
561 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
562 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
563 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
564 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
565 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
569 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
570 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
571 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
572 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
573 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
574 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
575 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
576 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
577 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
578 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
579 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
583 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
584 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
585 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
586 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
587 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
588 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
589 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
590 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
591 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
593 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
595 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
596 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
597 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
598 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
599 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
600 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
604 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
605 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
606 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
607 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
608 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
609 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
613 * Configuration:: Defining projects
614 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
615 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
616 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
620 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
621 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
622 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
623 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
624 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
625 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
626 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
627 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
631 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
632 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
634 Working with source code
636 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
637 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
638 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
639 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
640 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
641 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
642 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
643 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
644 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
645 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
646 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
647 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
651 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
652 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
654 Using header arguments
656 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
657 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
658 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
659 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
660 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
661 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
663 Specific header arguments
665 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
666 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
667 be collected and handled
668 * file:: Specify a path for file output
669 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
670 directory for code block execution
671 * exports:: Export code and/or results
672 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
673 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
675 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
676 expansion during tangling
677 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
678 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
679 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
680 * sep:: Specify delimiter for writing external tables
681 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
682 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
683 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
684 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
685 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
689 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
690 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
691 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
692 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
693 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
694 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
695 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
696 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
697 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
698 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
700 Interaction with other packages
702 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
703 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
707 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
708 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
709 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
710 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
711 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
712 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
713 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
714 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
715 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
716 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
718 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
720 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
721 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
722 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
723 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
727 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
728 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
729 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
734 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
735 @chapter Introduction
739 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
740 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
741 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
742 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
743 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
746 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
750 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
751 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
753 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
754 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
755 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
756 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
757 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
758 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
759 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
760 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
761 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
762 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
763 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
764 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
765 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
768 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
769 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
770 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
772 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
773 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
774 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
776 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
777 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
778 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
779 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
780 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
781 the minor Orgstruct mode.
783 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
784 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
785 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
786 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
790 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
791 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
792 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
793 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
794 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
795 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
796 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
797 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
798 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
803 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
804 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
805 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
806 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
808 @cindex print edition
809 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
810 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
816 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
817 @section Installation
821 @b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
822 distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
823 to @ref{Activation}. To see what version of Org (if any) is part of your
824 Emacs distribution, type @kbd{M-x load-library RET org} and then @kbd{M-x
827 If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
828 or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
829 to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
830 top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
831 binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
832 directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
833 access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
834 the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
835 Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
838 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
842 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
843 step for this directory:
846 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
849 @noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
855 @noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
856 all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
863 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
864 @file{install-info} program. In Debian it copies the info files into the
865 correct directory and modifies the info directory file. In many other
866 systems, the files need to be copied to the correct directory separately, and
867 @file{install-info} then only modifies the directory file. Check your system
868 documentation to find out which of the following commands you need:
872 make install-info-debian
875 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
876 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
877 when Org-mode starts.
879 (require 'org-install)
882 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
885 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
889 @cindex global key bindings
890 @cindex key bindings, global
892 To make sure files with extension @file{.org} use Org mode, add the following
893 line to your @file{.emacs} file.
895 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
897 @noindent Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on - this is the
898 default in Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in
899 Org buffer with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
901 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
902 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
903 global keys (i.e.@: anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
904 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
907 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
908 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
909 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
910 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
913 @cindex Org-mode, turning on
914 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
915 into Org-mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
919 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
922 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
923 @noindent which will select Org-mode for this buffer no matter what
924 the file's name is. See also the variable
925 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
927 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
928 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
929 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
930 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
932 (transient-mark-mode 1)
934 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
935 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
936 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
938 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
945 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
946 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
947 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
948 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
949 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
950 moderators have to do.}.
952 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
953 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
954 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
955 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
956 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
957 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
958 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
960 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
962 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
963 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
964 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
966 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
967 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
971 @item What exactly did you do?
972 @item What did you expect to happen?
973 @item What happened instead?
975 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
977 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
979 @cindex backtrace of an error
980 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
981 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
982 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
983 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
984 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
988 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org-mode Lisp files. The backtrace
989 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
992 C-u M-x org-reload RET
995 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
998 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
999 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1001 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1002 document the steps you take.
1004 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1005 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1006 attach it to your bug report.
1009 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1010 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1012 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
1013 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1018 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1022 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1023 meaning are written with all capitals.
1026 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1027 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1030 The manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for accessing
1031 functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different functions,
1032 depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has a generic
1033 name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever possible,
1034 give the function that is internally called by the generic command. For
1035 example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will be
1036 listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it will
1037 be listed to call org-table-move-column-right.
1039 If you prefer, you can compile the manual without the command names by
1040 unsetting the flag @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1042 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1043 @chapter Document structure
1044 @cindex document structure
1045 @cindex structure of document
1047 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1048 edit the structure of the document.
1051 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1052 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1053 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1054 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1055 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1056 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1057 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1058 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1059 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1060 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1061 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1064 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1067 @cindex Outline mode
1069 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1070 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1071 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1072 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1073 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1074 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1075 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1076 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1078 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1081 @cindex outline tree
1082 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1083 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1084 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1086 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1087 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1088 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1089 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1090 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.}. For example:
1093 * Top level headline
1100 * Another top level headline
1103 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1104 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1105 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1107 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1108 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1109 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1110 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1111 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1112 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1114 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1115 @section Visibility cycling
1116 @cindex cycling, visibility
1117 @cindex visibility cycling
1118 @cindex trees, visibility
1119 @cindex show hidden text
1122 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1123 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1124 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1126 @cindex subtree visibility states
1127 @cindex subtree cycling
1128 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1129 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1130 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1132 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1133 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1136 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1137 '-----------------------------------'
1140 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1141 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1142 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1143 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1144 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1145 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1146 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1147 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1149 @cindex global visibility states
1150 @cindex global cycling
1151 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1152 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1153 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1154 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1155 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1156 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1159 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1160 '--------------------------------------'
1163 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1164 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1165 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1167 @cindex show all, command
1168 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1169 Show all, including drawers.
1170 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1171 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1172 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1173 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1174 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1175 level, all sibling headings. With double prefix arg, also show the entire
1176 subtree of the parent.
1177 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1178 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1179 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1180 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1183 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1186 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1188 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1189 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1190 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1191 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1192 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1193 the previously used indirect buffer.
1196 @vindex org-startup-folded
1197 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1198 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1199 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1200 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1202 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1203 OVERVIEW, i.e.@: only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1204 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1205 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1212 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1215 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1217 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1218 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1219 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1222 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1223 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e.@: whatever is
1224 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1228 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1230 @cindex motion, between headlines
1231 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1232 @cindex headline navigation
1233 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1236 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1238 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1240 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1241 Next heading same level.
1242 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1243 Previous heading same level.
1244 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1245 Backward to higher level heading.
1246 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1247 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1248 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1249 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1250 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1252 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1253 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1254 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1255 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1256 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1257 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1258 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1260 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1263 @vindex org-goto-interface
1265 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1268 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1269 @section Structure editing
1270 @cindex structure editing
1271 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1272 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1273 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1274 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1275 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1276 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1277 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1278 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1279 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1282 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1283 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1284 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
1285 plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
1286 creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
1287 to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
1288 the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
1289 the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
1290 customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
1291 command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
1292 created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
1293 the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
1294 used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.@: behind the ellipses at the end
1295 of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
1296 after the end of the subtree.
1297 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1298 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1299 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1300 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1301 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1302 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1303 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1304 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1305 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1306 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1307 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1309 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1310 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1311 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1312 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1313 to the initial level.
1314 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1315 Promote current heading by one level.
1316 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1317 Demote current heading by one level.
1318 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1319 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1320 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1321 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1322 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1323 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1325 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1326 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1327 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1328 Kill subtree, i.e.@: remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1329 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1330 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1331 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1332 sequential subtrees.
1333 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1334 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1335 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1336 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1337 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1338 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1339 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1340 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1341 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1342 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1343 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1344 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1345 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1346 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1347 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1348 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1349 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1351 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1352 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1353 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1354 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1355 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1356 more details, see the docstring of the command
1357 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1358 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1359 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1360 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort-entries-or-items}
1361 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1362 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1363 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1364 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1365 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1366 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1367 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1368 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1369 sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes, duplicate
1370 entries will also be removed.
1371 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1372 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1373 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1374 Narrow buffer to current block.
1375 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1376 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1377 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1378 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1379 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1380 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1381 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1382 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1383 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1386 @cindex region, active
1387 @cindex active region
1388 @cindex transient mark mode
1389 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1390 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1391 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1392 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1393 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1394 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1398 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1399 @section Sparse trees
1400 @cindex sparse trees
1401 @cindex trees, sparse
1402 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1403 @cindex occur, command
1405 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1406 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1407 @vindex org-show-siblings
1408 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1409 An important feature of Org-mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1410 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1411 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1412 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1413 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1414 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1415 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1416 and you will see immediately how it works.
1418 Org-mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1419 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1422 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1423 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1424 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1425 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1426 Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1427 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1428 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1429 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1430 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1431 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1432 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1433 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1434 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1435 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1436 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1437 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1438 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1439 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1444 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1445 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1446 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1447 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1448 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1452 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1453 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1456 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1457 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1459 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1460 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1463 @cindex printing sparse trees
1464 @cindex visible text, printing
1465 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1466 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1467 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1468 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1469 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1470 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1472 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1473 @section Plain lists
1475 @cindex lists, plain
1476 @cindex lists, ordered
1477 @cindex ordered lists
1479 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1480 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1481 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1482 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1484 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1487 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1488 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1489 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1490 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
1491 visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
1492 @samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
1495 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1496 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1497 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1498 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1499 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1500 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1501 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1502 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1503 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1504 list to start with a different value (e.g.@: 20), start the text of the item
1505 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1506 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1507 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1508 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1510 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1511 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1515 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1516 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1517 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1518 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1519 than the bullet/number.
1521 @vindex org-list-ending-method
1522 @vindex org-list-end-regexp
1523 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1524 Two methods@footnote{To disable either of them, configure
1525 @code{org-list-ending-method}.} are provided to terminate lists. A list ends
1526 whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less or equally
1527 indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1528 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1529 that case, all items are closed. For finer control, you can end lists with
1530 any pattern set in @code{org-list-end-regexp}. Here is an example:
1534 ** Lord of the Rings
1535 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1536 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1537 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1538 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1539 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1540 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1542 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1543 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1544 Important actors in this film are:
1545 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1546 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1547 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1551 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1552 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1553 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1554 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1555 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1556 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1557 blocks can be indented to signal that they should be considered as a list
1560 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1561 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1562 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1563 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}.
1565 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1566 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1567 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1568 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1569 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1570 to disable them individually.
1573 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1574 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1575 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1576 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1577 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1578 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1579 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the
1580 indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real
1581 headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated.
1582 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1583 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1584 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1585 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1586 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1587 of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
1588 item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
1589 @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed @emph{before
1590 an item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current item. If the
1591 command is executed in the white space before the text that is part of an
1592 item but does not contain the bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
1594 As a new item cannot be inserted in a structural construct (like an example
1595 or source code block) within a list, Org will instead insert it right before
1596 the structure, or return an error.
1597 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1599 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1600 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1601 In a new item with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the item to
1602 become a child of the previous one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to
1603 meaningful levels in the list and eventually get it back to its initial
1605 @kindex S-@key{down}
1608 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1609 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1610 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
1611 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1612 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1614 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1615 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1617 @itemx M-S-@key{down}
1618 Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
1619 of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
1621 @kindex M-@key{left}
1622 @kindex M-@key{right}
1624 @itemx M-@key{right}
1625 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1626 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1627 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1628 @item M-S-@key{left}
1629 @itemx M-S-@key{right}
1630 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1631 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1632 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1633 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1634 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1637 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1638 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1639 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1640 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1643 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1644 state of the checkbox. Also, makes sure that all the
1645 items on this list level use the same bullet and that the numbering of list
1646 items (if applicable) is correct.
1648 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1649 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1651 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1652 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1653 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1654 and its position@footnote{See @code{bullet} rule in
1655 @code{org-list-automatic-rules} for more information.}. With a numeric
1656 prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an
1657 active region when calling this, selected text will be changed into an item.
1658 With a prefix argument, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
1659 first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed from the
1660 list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1661 converted into a list item.
1664 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1665 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1668 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1669 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1671 @kindex S-@key{left}
1672 @kindex S-@key{right}
1673 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
1674 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1675 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1676 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1677 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1680 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1681 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1684 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1688 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1691 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1692 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org-mode has @emph{drawers}.
1693 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1694 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
1695 with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
1699 ** This is a headline
1700 Still outside the drawer
1702 This is inside the drawer.
1707 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1708 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1709 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1710 press @key{TAB} there. Org-mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1711 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1712 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1713 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1714 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1719 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1722 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1725 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1726 @cindex blocks, folding
1727 Org-mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1728 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1729 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1730 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1731 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1732 or on a per-file basis by using
1734 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1735 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1737 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1738 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1741 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1745 Org-mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1746 @file{footnote.el} package, Org-mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1747 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1748 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e.@: a footnote is
1749 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1750 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1751 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1752 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1755 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1757 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1760 Org-mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1761 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1762 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1763 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1764 LaTeX}). Here are the valid references:
1768 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1769 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1772 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1773 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1774 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1775 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1777 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1778 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1779 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1780 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1783 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1784 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1785 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1786 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1789 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1794 The footnote action command.
1796 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1797 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1799 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1800 @vindex org-footnote-section
1801 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1802 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1803 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1804 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1805 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1806 separately into the location determined by the variable
1807 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1809 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1812 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1813 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1814 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1815 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1816 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1817 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1818 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1819 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1820 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1821 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1822 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1823 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1824 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1825 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g.@: sending}
1826 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1827 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1828 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1831 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1832 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1833 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1838 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1839 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1840 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1844 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1845 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1846 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1849 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1850 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1851 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1852 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1854 If you like the intuitive way the Org-mode structure editing and list
1855 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1856 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1857 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1858 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
1861 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1862 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1865 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1866 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1867 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1868 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1869 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
1870 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1871 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1874 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1877 @cindex editing tables
1879 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1880 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
1882 (@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1885 (see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
1890 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1891 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
1892 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1893 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1894 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1895 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
1898 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
1899 @section The built-in table editor
1900 @cindex table editor, built-in
1902 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
1903 @samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
1904 table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
1908 | Name | Phone | Age |
1909 |-------+-------+-----|
1910 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1911 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1914 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1915 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1916 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1917 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
1918 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
1919 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
1920 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
1921 create the above table, you would only type
1928 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
1929 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
1930 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
1932 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
1933 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
1934 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
1935 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
1936 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
1937 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
1938 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
1939 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
1940 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
1941 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
1944 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
1945 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
1946 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
1947 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
1948 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
1949 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
1950 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
1951 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
1952 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
1954 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
1955 table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
1956 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
1958 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
1959 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
1960 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
1962 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
1963 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
1966 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
1967 Re-align, move to previous field.
1969 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
1970 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
1971 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
1972 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
1974 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
1975 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
1976 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
1977 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
1979 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
1980 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
1981 Move the current column left/right.
1983 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
1984 Kill the current column.
1986 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
1987 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
1989 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
1990 Move the current row up/down.
1992 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
1993 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
1995 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
1996 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
1997 created below the current one.
1999 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2000 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2001 is created above the current line.
2003 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2004 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2007 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2008 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2009 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2010 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2011 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2012 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2013 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2014 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2015 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2016 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2018 @tsubheading{Regions}
2019 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2020 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2021 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2022 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2024 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2025 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2026 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2028 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2029 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2030 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2031 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2032 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2035 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2036 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2037 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2038 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2039 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2040 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2041 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2044 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2045 @cindex formula, in tables
2046 @cindex calculations, in tables
2047 @cindex region, active
2048 @cindex active region
2049 @cindex transient mark mode
2050 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2051 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2052 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2053 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2055 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2056 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2057 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2058 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2059 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2060 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2061 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2062 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2063 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2065 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2066 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2067 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2068 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2069 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2072 @item M-x org-table-import
2073 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2074 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2075 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2076 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2077 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2078 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2080 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2081 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2082 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2083 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2085 @item M-x org-table-export
2086 @findex org-table-export
2087 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2088 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2089 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2090 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2091 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2092 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2093 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2094 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2095 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2096 detailed description.
2099 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2100 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2104 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2107 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2108 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2110 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2111 @section Column width and alignment
2112 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2113 @cindex alignment in tables
2115 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2116 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2117 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2119 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2120 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2121 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2122 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2123 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2124 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2125 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2129 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2131 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2132 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2133 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2134 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2135 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2140 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2141 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2142 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2143 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2144 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2145 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2148 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2149 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2150 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2151 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2152 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2153 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2154 on a per-file basis with:
2161 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2162 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2163 @samp{c}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2164 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2165 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2167 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2168 automatically when exporting the document.
2170 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2171 @section Column groups
2172 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2174 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2175 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2176 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2177 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2178 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2179 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2180 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2181 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
2182 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2183 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2186 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2187 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2188 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2189 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2190 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2191 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2192 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2193 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2196 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2197 every vertical line you would like to have:
2200 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2201 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2205 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2206 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2208 @cindex minor mode for tables
2210 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2211 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2212 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2213 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2214 example in Message mode, use
2217 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2220 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2221 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2222 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2223 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2224 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2226 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2227 @section The spreadsheet
2228 @cindex calculations, in tables
2229 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2230 @cindex @file{calc} package
2232 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2233 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2234 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2235 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2236 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2237 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2238 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2239 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2240 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2243 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2244 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2245 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2246 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
2247 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2248 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2249 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2250 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
2253 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2254 @subsection References
2257 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2258 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2259 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2260 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2261 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2263 @subsubheading Field references
2264 @cindex field references
2265 @cindex references, to fields
2267 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2268 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2269 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2270 @c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
2271 @c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
2272 @c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
2275 Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
2277 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2281 Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{@var{N}},
2282 or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
2284 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
2285 separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
2286 @samp{1}...@samp{@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
2287 @samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
2288 hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
2289 hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
2290 starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
2291 the second, etc@. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
2292 current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
2293 You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
2294 third hline in the table.
2296 @samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
2297 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
2298 row/column is implied.
2300 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2301 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2302 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2303 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2304 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2305 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2307 As a special case, references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used
2308 to refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
2311 Here are a few examples:
2314 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
2315 C2 @r{same as previous}
2316 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
2317 E& @r{same as previous}
2318 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2319 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2320 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2323 @subsubheading Range references
2324 @cindex range references
2325 @cindex references, to ranges
2327 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2328 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2329 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2330 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2331 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2332 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2335 $1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
2336 $P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2337 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
2338 A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
2339 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2342 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2343 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2344 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2345 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2346 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2348 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2349 @cindex field coordinates
2350 @cindex coordinates, of field
2351 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2352 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2354 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2355 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2356 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2357 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2360 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2361 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2362 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2365 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2366 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2367 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2370 @subsubheading Named references
2371 @cindex named references
2372 @cindex references, named
2373 @cindex name, of column or field
2374 @cindex constants, in calculations
2377 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2378 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2379 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2380 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2384 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2388 @vindex constants-unit-system
2389 @pindex constants.el
2390 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2391 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2392 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2393 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2394 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2395 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2396 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2397 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2398 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2399 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2400 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2401 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2402 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2403 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2406 @subsubheading Remote references
2407 @cindex remote references
2408 @cindex references, remote
2409 @cindex references, to a different table
2410 @cindex name, of column or field
2411 @cindex constants, in calculations
2414 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2415 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2418 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2422 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2423 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2424 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2425 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2426 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2429 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2430 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2431 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2432 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2434 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2435 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2436 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2437 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2438 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2439 Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
2440 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2441 @c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
2442 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2443 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2444 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2445 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2447 @cindex format specifier
2448 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2449 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2450 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2451 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2452 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2453 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2454 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2455 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2456 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2459 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2460 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2461 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2462 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2463 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2464 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2465 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2466 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2467 T @r{force text interpretation}
2468 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2473 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2474 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2475 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2476 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2477 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2478 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2479 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2480 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2481 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2485 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2486 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2487 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2488 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2489 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2490 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2491 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2492 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2493 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2494 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2495 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2498 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2501 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2504 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2505 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2506 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2508 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful for
2509 string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is not
2510 enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening
2511 parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should
2512 return either a string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you
2513 can specify modes and a printf format after a semicolon. With Emacs Lisp
2514 forms, you need to be conscious about the way field references are
2515 interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be interpolated as
2516 a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If you provide the
2517 @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers (non-number
2518 fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If
2519 you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally,
2520 without quotes. i.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string
2521 by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes,
2522 like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2523 +embed them in list or vector syntax. Here are a few examples---note how the
2524 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp:
2527 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2528 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2529 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2531 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2532 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2535 @node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2536 @subsection Field formulas
2537 @cindex field formula
2538 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2540 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
2541 field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
2542 press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
2543 the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
2544 evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
2547 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
2548 directly below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of
2549 the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
2550 @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
2551 with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
2552 ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
2553 same field. Of course this is not true if you edit the table structure
2554 with normal editing commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2555 The left-hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
2556 features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
2558 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2562 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2563 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2564 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2565 it to the current field, and stores it.
2568 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
2569 @subsection Column formulas
2570 @cindex column formula
2571 @cindex formula, for table column
2573 Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
2574 particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
2575 in that column, Org allows you to assign a single formula to an entire
2576 column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
2577 before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
2578 and will not be modified by column formulas.
2580 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2581 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2582 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2583 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2584 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2585 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2586 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2587 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The left-hand
2588 side of a column formula cannot currently be the name of column, it
2589 must be the numeric column reference.
2591 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2595 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2596 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2597 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2598 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2599 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g.@: @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2600 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2603 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2604 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2605 @cindex formula editing
2606 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2608 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2609 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2610 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2611 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2612 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2613 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2614 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2615 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2618 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2619 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2620 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field formulas}.
2621 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2622 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2623 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2624 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2625 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2626 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2627 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2628 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2630 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2632 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2633 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2634 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2636 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2638 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2639 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2640 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2641 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2642 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2643 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2644 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2645 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2646 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2648 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2649 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2650 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2651 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2652 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2653 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2654 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2655 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2656 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2657 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2658 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2659 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2660 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2661 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2662 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2664 @kindex S-@key{down}
2665 @kindex S-@key{left}
2666 @kindex S-@key{right}
2667 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2668 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2669 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2670 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2671 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2672 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2673 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2674 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2675 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2676 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2678 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2679 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2681 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2683 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2687 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2688 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2689 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2690 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2691 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2694 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2695 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2696 recalculation commands in the table.
2698 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2699 @cindex formula debugging
2700 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2701 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2702 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2703 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2704 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2705 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2706 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2708 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2709 @subsection Updating the table
2710 @cindex recomputing table fields
2711 @cindex updating, table
2713 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2714 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2715 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2717 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2721 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2722 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2723 from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
2729 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2730 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2732 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2733 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2734 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2735 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2736 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2737 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2738 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2739 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2740 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2741 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2745 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2746 @subsection Advanced features
2748 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
2749 you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
2750 to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
2752 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2753 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2754 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2755 change all marks in the region.
2758 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2759 makes use of these features:
2763 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2764 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2765 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2766 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2767 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2768 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2769 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2770 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2771 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2772 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2773 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2774 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2775 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2776 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2777 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2781 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2782 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2783 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2784 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2787 @cindex marking characters, tables
2788 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2791 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2792 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2794 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2795 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2796 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2797 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2799 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2802 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2803 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2804 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2805 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2808 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2809 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2810 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2811 lines will be left alone by this command.
2813 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2814 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2815 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2817 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2818 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2821 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2822 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
2825 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
2826 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2827 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2832 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2833 | | Func | n | x | Result |
2834 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2835 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2836 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2837 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2838 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2839 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2840 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2841 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2842 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2846 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2848 @cindex graph, in tables
2849 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
2852 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
2853 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
2854 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
2855 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
2856 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
2860 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
2861 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
2862 |-----------+-----------+---------|
2863 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
2864 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
2865 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
2866 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2867 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
2871 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
2872 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
2873 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
2874 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
2875 see the Org-plot tutorial at
2876 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
2878 @subsubheading Plot Options
2882 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
2885 Specify the title of the plot.
2888 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
2891 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
2892 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
2893 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
2897 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
2900 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
2901 (e.g.@: @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
2902 Defaults to @code{lines}.
2905 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
2908 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
2912 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
2915 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
2916 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
2919 Specify format of Org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
2920 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
2923 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
2924 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
2925 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
2926 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
2927 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
2931 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
2935 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
2936 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
2939 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
2940 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
2941 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
2942 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
2943 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
2944 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
2945 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
2946 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
2949 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
2950 @section Link format
2952 @cindex format, of links
2954 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
2955 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
2958 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
2962 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
2963 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
2964 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
2965 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
2966 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
2967 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
2968 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
2969 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
2972 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
2973 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
2974 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
2975 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
2976 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
2977 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
2978 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
2980 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
2981 @section Internal links
2982 @cindex internal links
2983 @cindex links, internal
2984 @cindex targets, for links
2986 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2987 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
2988 current file. The most important case is a link like
2989 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
2990 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
2991 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
2992 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
2995 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
2996 lead to a text search in the current file.
2998 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
2999 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3000 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3001 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3002 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3003 comment line. For example
3009 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3010 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3011 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3012 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3015 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3016 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3017 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3018 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3019 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3020 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3021 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3023 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3024 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3025 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3029 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3032 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3033 @subsection Radio targets
3034 @cindex radio targets
3035 @cindex targets, radio
3036 @cindex links, radio targets
3038 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3039 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3040 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3041 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3042 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3043 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3044 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3045 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3046 cursor on or at a target.
3048 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3049 @section External links
3050 @cindex links, external
3051 @cindex external links
3052 @cindex links, external
3060 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3062 @cindex USENET links
3067 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3068 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3069 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3070 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3071 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3074 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3075 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3076 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3077 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3078 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3079 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3080 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3081 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3082 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file with line number to jump to}
3083 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3084 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}
3085 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3086 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open file in doc-view mode at page NNN}
3087 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3088 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3089 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3090 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3091 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3092 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3093 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3094 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3095 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3096 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3097 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3098 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3099 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3100 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3101 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3102 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3103 info:org#External%20links @r{Info node link (with encoded space)}
3104 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3105 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3106 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3109 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3111 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3112 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3113 format}), for example:
3116 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3120 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3121 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3122 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3124 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3126 @cindex square brackets, around links
3127 @cindex plain text external links
3128 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3129 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3130 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3131 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3133 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3134 @section Handling links
3135 @cindex links, handling
3137 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3138 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3141 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3142 @cindex storing links
3143 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3144 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3145 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3146 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3149 @b{Org-mode buffers}@*
3150 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3151 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3154 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
3155 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3156 @cindex property, ID
3157 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3158 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3159 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
3160 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
3161 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3162 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3163 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3166 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3167 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3168 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3169 constructed from the author and the subject.
3171 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3172 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3174 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3175 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3178 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3179 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3180 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3181 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3182 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3185 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3186 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3187 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3188 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3189 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3190 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3191 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3194 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3195 entry referenced by the current line.
3198 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3199 @cindex link completion
3200 @cindex completion, of links
3201 @cindex inserting links
3202 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3203 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3204 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3205 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3206 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3207 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3208 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3209 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3210 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3211 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3212 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3213 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3214 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3215 becomes the default description.
3217 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3218 All links stored during the
3219 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3220 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3222 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3223 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3224 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3225 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3226 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3227 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3228 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3229 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3230 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3232 @cindex file name completion
3233 @cindex completion, of file names
3234 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3235 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3236 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3237 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3238 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3239 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3240 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3241 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3243 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3244 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3245 link and description parts of the link.
3247 @cindex following links
3248 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3249 @vindex org-file-apps
3250 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3251 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3252 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3253 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3254 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3255 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3256 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3257 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3258 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3259 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3260 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3261 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3262 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3263 headline and entry text.
3265 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3266 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3273 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3274 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3278 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3279 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3280 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3281 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3283 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3284 @cindex inlining images
3285 @cindex images, inlining
3286 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3287 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3288 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3289 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3290 images that have no description part in the link, i.e.@: images that will also
3291 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3292 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3293 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3294 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3295 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3296 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3298 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3299 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3301 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3302 @cindex links, returning to
3303 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3304 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3305 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3306 previously recorded positions.
3308 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3309 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3310 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3311 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3312 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3313 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3315 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3317 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3318 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3322 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3323 @section Using links outside Org
3325 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3326 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3327 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3331 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3332 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3335 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3336 @section Link abbreviations
3337 @cindex link abbreviations
3338 @cindex abbreviation, links
3340 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3341 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3342 abbreviated link looks like this
3345 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3349 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3350 where the tag is optional.
3351 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3352 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3353 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3354 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3358 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3359 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3360 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3361 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3362 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3363 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3367 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3368 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
3369 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
3370 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3372 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3373 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3374 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3375 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3376 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3377 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3378 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3380 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3381 can define them in the file with
3385 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3386 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3390 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3391 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3392 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
3393 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3394 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3396 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3397 @section Search options in file links
3398 @cindex search option in file links
3399 @cindex file links, searching
3401 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3402 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3403 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3404 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3405 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3406 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3407 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3408 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3410 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3411 link, together with an explanation:
3414 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3415 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3416 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3417 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3418 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3425 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3426 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3427 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3428 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3431 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3433 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3435 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3436 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3437 target file is in Org-mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3438 sparse tree with the matches.
3439 @c If the target file is a directory,
3440 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3443 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3444 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3445 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3446 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3448 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3449 @section Custom Searches
3450 @cindex custom search strings
3451 @cindex search strings, custom
3453 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3454 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3455 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3456 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3457 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3460 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3461 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3462 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3463 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3464 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3465 to be added to the hook variables
3466 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3467 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3468 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3469 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3470 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3472 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3476 Org-mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3477 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3478 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3479 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3480 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3481 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3482 item emerged is always present.
3484 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3485 throughout your notes file. Org-mode compensates for this by providing
3486 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3489 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3490 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3491 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3492 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3493 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3494 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3497 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3498 @section Basic TODO functionality
3500 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3501 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3504 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3508 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3511 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3512 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3513 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3516 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3517 '--------------------------------'
3520 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3521 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3523 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3524 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3525 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3526 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3529 @kindex S-@key{right}
3530 @kindex S-@key{left}
3531 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3532 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3533 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3534 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3535 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3536 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3537 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3538 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-key}
3539 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3540 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3541 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3542 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3543 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3544 / T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3545 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3546 entries that match any one of these keywords. With numeric prefix argument
3547 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3548 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3549 both un-done and done.
3550 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3551 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3552 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3553 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3554 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3555 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3556 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3557 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3561 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3562 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3563 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3565 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3566 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3567 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3569 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3570 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3571 DONE. Org-mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3572 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3573 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3576 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3577 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3580 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3581 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3582 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3583 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3584 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3585 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3586 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3589 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3590 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3591 @cindex TODO workflow
3592 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3594 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3595 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3596 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org-mode in a
3600 (setq org-todo-keywords
3601 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3604 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3605 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3606 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3608 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3609 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3610 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3611 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3612 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3613 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3614 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3615 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3616 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3617 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3618 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3620 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3621 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3623 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3624 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3626 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3627 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3628 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3629 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3630 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3631 be set up like this:
3634 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3637 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3638 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3639 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org-mode supports this style by adapting
3640 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3641 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3642 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3643 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3644 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3645 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3646 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3647 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3648 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3649 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3650 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3652 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3653 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3654 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3656 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3657 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3658 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3659 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3660 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3664 (setq org-todo-keywords
3665 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3666 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3667 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3670 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org-mode to keep track
3671 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3672 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3673 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3674 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3675 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3676 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3679 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3680 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3681 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3682 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3683 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3684 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3685 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3686 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3687 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3688 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3689 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3690 @kindex S-@key{right}
3691 @kindex S-@key{left}
3694 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3695 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3696 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3697 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3698 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3701 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3702 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3704 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3705 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3706 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3707 key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
3710 (setq org-todo-keywords
3711 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3712 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3713 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3716 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3717 If you then press @code{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3718 will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3719 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3720 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3721 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3722 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3723 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3725 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3726 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3727 @cindex keyword options
3728 @cindex per-file keywords
3733 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3734 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3735 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3736 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3737 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3741 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3743 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3744 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3746 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3749 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3753 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3757 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3759 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3760 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3762 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3763 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3764 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3765 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3766 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3767 known to Org-mode@footnote{Org-mode parses these lines only when
3768 Org-mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3769 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org-mode
3770 for the current buffer.}.
3772 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3773 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3774 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3776 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3777 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3778 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3779 Org-mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3780 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3781 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3782 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3783 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3784 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3788 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3789 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
3790 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3794 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
3795 work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
3796 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
3797 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
3798 foreground or a background color.
3800 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
3801 @subsection TODO dependencies
3802 @cindex TODO dependencies
3803 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
3805 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3806 @cindex property, ORDERED
3807 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
3808 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
3809 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
3810 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
3811 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
3812 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
3813 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
3814 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
3815 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
3819 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
3828 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
3829 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
3833 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
3834 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3835 @cindex property, ORDERED
3836 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
3837 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
3838 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
3839 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
3840 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
3841 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
3842 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
3845 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
3846 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
3847 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
3848 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
3850 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
3851 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3852 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
3853 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
3854 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
3855 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
3857 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
3858 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
3859 module @file{org-depend.el}.
3862 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
3863 @section Progress logging
3864 @cindex progress logging
3865 @cindex logging, of progress
3867 Org-mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
3868 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
3869 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
3870 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
3871 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
3875 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
3876 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
3877 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
3880 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
3881 @subsection Closing items
3883 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
3884 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
3885 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
3888 (setq org-log-done 'time)
3892 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
3893 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
3894 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
3895 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
3896 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
3897 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
3900 (setq org-log-done 'note)
3904 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
3905 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
3907 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
3908 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
3909 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
3910 giving you an overview of what has been done.
3912 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
3913 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
3914 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
3916 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
3917 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
3918 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
3919 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
3920 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
3921 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
3922 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
3923 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
3924 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
3925 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
3926 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this
3927 behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}. You can
3928 also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
3929 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
3931 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org-mode
3932 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
3933 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note)
3934 in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting
3937 (setq org-todo-keywords
3938 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
3942 @vindex org-log-done
3943 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
3944 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
3945 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org-mode will record two timestamps
3946 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
3947 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
3948 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
3949 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
3950 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
3951 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
3952 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
3953 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
3954 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
3955 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
3956 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
3957 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
3960 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
3963 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
3966 @cindex property, LOGGING
3967 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
3968 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
3969 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
3970 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
3971 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
3972 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
3975 * TODO Log each state with only a time
3977 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
3979 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
3981 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
3983 * TODO No logging at all
3989 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
3990 @subsection Tracking your habits
3993 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
3994 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
3998 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4001 The habit is a TODO, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4003 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4005 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4006 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4007 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4008 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4010 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4011 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4012 three days, but at most every two days.
4014 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
4015 for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it's not
4016 enabled it's not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
4020 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4021 actual habit with some history:
4025 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4026 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4027 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4028 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4029 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4030 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4031 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4032 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4033 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4034 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4035 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4038 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4042 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4043 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4044 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4045 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4046 after four days have elapsed.
4048 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4049 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4050 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4051 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4055 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4057 If the task could have been done on that day.
4059 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4061 If the task was overdue on that day.
4064 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4065 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4066 the current day falls in the graph.
4068 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4069 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4072 @item org-habit-graph-column
4073 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4074 overwrite any text in that column, so it's a good idea to keep your habits'
4075 titles brief and to the point.
4076 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4077 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4078 @item org-habit-following-days
4079 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4080 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4081 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4085 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4086 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4087 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4088 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4090 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4094 If you use Org-mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4095 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4096 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4099 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4103 @vindex org-priority-faces
4104 By default, Org-mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4105 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4106 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4107 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4108 have no inherent meaning to Org-mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4109 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4111 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4117 @findex org-priority
4118 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4119 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4120 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4121 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4122 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4124 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4125 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4126 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4127 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4128 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4129 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4130 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4133 @vindex org-highest-priority
4134 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4135 @vindex org-default-priority
4136 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4137 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4138 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4139 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4140 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4143 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4148 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4149 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4150 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4151 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4153 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4154 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4155 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4156 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4157 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4158 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4159 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4160 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4161 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4164 * Organize Party [33%]
4165 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4169 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4172 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4173 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4174 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4175 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4178 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4179 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4180 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4181 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4182 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4186 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4188 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4192 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4193 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4196 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4197 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4198 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4199 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4201 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4205 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4206 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4209 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4213 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4214 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4215 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4216 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4217 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4218 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4219 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4220 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4221 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4222 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4224 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4227 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4228 - [-] call people [1/3]
4233 - [ ] think about what music to play
4234 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4237 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4238 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4239 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4242 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4243 @cindex checkbox statistics
4244 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4245 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4246 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4247 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4248 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4249 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4250 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4251 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4252 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4253 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4254 represent the all checkboxes below the cookie, not just the direct
4255 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4256 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4257 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4258 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4259 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4260 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4261 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4262 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4264 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4265 @cindex checkbox blocking
4266 @cindex property, ORDERED
4267 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4268 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4269 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4271 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4274 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4275 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4276 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4278 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4279 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4280 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4284 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4285 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4286 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4288 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4289 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4291 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4293 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4294 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4295 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4296 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4297 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4298 @cindex property, ORDERED
4299 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4300 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4301 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4302 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4303 for better visibility, customize the variable
4304 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4305 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4306 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4307 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4308 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4309 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4310 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4311 hand, use this command to get things back into sync. Or simply toggle any
4312 entry twice (checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c}).
4315 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4318 @cindex headline tagging
4319 @cindex matching, tags
4320 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4322 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4323 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org-mode has extensive
4326 @vindex org-tag-faces
4327 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4328 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4329 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4330 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4331 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4332 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4333 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4334 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4337 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4338 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4339 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4342 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4343 @section Tag inheritance
4344 @cindex tag inheritance
4345 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4346 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4348 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4349 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4350 well. For example, in the list
4353 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4354 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4355 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4359 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4360 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4361 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4362 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4363 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4364 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4365 changes in the line.}:
4369 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4373 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4374 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4375 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4376 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4377 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4379 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4380 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4381 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4382 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4383 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4384 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4385 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4386 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4388 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4389 @section Setting tags
4390 @cindex setting tags
4391 @cindex tags, setting
4394 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4395 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4396 also a special command for inserting tags:
4399 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4400 @cindex completion, of tags
4401 @vindex org-tags-column
4402 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org-mode will either offer
4403 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4404 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4405 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4406 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4407 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4408 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4409 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4410 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4413 @vindex org-tag-alist
4414 Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4415 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4416 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4417 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4418 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4422 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4423 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4426 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4427 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4428 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4434 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4435 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4436 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4437 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4438 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4439 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4445 By default Org-mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4446 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4447 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4448 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4449 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4450 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4451 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4452 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4456 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4459 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4460 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4463 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4466 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4467 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4468 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4471 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4474 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4477 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4478 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4482 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4486 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4489 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4490 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4492 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4493 these lines to activate any changes.
4496 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4497 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4498 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4499 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4503 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4504 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4505 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4507 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4510 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4511 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4512 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4513 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4514 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4519 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4520 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4521 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4524 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4525 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4526 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4530 Clear all tags for this line.
4533 Accept the modified set.
4535 Abort without installing changes.
4537 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4539 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4540 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4542 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4543 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4548 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4549 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4550 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4551 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4552 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4553 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4554 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4555 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4557 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4558 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4559 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4560 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4561 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4562 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4563 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4564 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4565 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4566 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4567 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4569 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4570 @section Tag searches
4571 @cindex tag searches
4572 @cindex searching for tags
4574 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4575 information into special lists.
4578 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4579 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4580 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4581 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4582 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4583 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4584 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4585 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4586 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4587 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4588 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4591 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4592 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4593 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4594 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4595 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4596 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4597 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4600 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4601 @chapter Properties and columns
4604 Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
4605 are two main applications for properties in Org-mode. First, properties
4606 are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
4607 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
4608 an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
4609 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4610 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
4611 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4612 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
4613 application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs,
4614 where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of
4615 release, number of tracks, and so on.
4617 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4618 (@pxref{Column view}).
4621 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4622 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
4623 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4624 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4625 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4626 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4629 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4630 @section Property syntax
4631 @cindex property syntax
4632 @cindex drawer, for properties
4634 Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
4635 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4636 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4637 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4642 *** Goldberg Variations
4644 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4645 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4647 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4652 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4653 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4654 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4655 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4656 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4657 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4658 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4663 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4664 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4668 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4669 file, use a line like
4670 @cindex property, _ALL
4673 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4676 @vindex org-global-properties
4677 Property values set with the global variable
4678 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4682 The following commands help to work with properties:
4685 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
4686 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4687 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4688 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4689 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4690 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4691 @item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
4692 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
4693 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4694 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4695 information like deadlines.
4696 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4697 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4698 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4699 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4700 can be inserted using completion.
4701 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4702 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4703 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4704 Remove a property from the current entry.
4705 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4706 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4707 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4708 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4709 nearest column format definition.
4712 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4713 @section Special properties
4714 @cindex properties, special
4716 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org-mode features,
4717 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
4718 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
4719 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
4720 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
4721 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4723 @cindex property, special, TODO
4724 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4725 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4726 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4727 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4728 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4729 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4730 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4731 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4732 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4733 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4734 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
4735 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4736 @cindex property, special, ITEM
4737 @cindex property, special, FILE
4739 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4740 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4741 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
4742 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
4743 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4744 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
4745 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
4746 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
4747 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
4748 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
4749 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4750 @r{must be run first to compute the values.}
4751 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
4752 ITEM @r{The content of the entry.}
4753 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
4756 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
4757 @section Property searches
4758 @cindex properties, searching
4759 @cindex searching, of properties
4761 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
4762 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
4764 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
4765 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
4766 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4767 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4768 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
4769 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4770 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4771 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4772 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4773 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
4774 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4777 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
4780 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
4785 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
4786 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
4787 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
4788 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
4789 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
4792 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
4793 @section Property Inheritance
4794 @cindex properties, inheritance
4795 @cindex inheritance, of properties
4797 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
4798 The outline structure of Org-mode documents lends itself to an
4799 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
4800 property, the children can inherit this property. Org-mode does not
4801 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
4802 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
4803 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
4804 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
4805 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
4806 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
4807 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
4808 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
4809 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
4811 Org-mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
4812 least for the special applications for which they are used:
4814 @cindex property, COLUMNS
4817 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
4818 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
4819 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
4820 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
4821 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
4823 @cindex property, CATEGORY
4824 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
4825 applies to the entire subtree.
4827 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
4828 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
4829 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
4831 @cindex property, LOGGING
4832 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
4833 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
4836 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
4837 @section Column view
4839 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
4840 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
4841 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
4842 entries. Org-mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
4843 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
4844 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
4845 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
4846 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
4847 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
4848 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
4849 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
4850 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
4851 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
4854 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
4855 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
4856 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
4859 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
4860 @subsection Defining columns
4861 @cindex column view, for properties
4862 @cindex properties, column view
4864 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
4865 done by defining a column format line.
4868 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
4869 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
4872 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
4873 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
4875 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
4879 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4882 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
4883 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
4886 ** Top node for columns view
4888 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4892 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
4893 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
4894 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
4895 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
4896 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
4897 deeper part of the tree.
4899 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
4900 @subsubsection Column attributes
4901 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
4902 definition looks like this:
4905 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
4909 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
4910 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
4913 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
4914 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
4915 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
4916 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
4917 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
4918 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
4920 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
4921 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
4922 @r{Supported summary types are:}
4923 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
4924 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
4925 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
4926 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
4927 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
4928 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
4929 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
4930 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
4931 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
4932 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
4933 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
4934 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
4935 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
4936 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4937 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4938 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4939 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
4943 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
4944 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
4945 same summary information.
4947 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
4948 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
4949 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
4950 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
4951 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
4952 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
4954 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
4955 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
4956 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
4957 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
4958 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
4959 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
4960 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
4961 full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
4963 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
4967 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
4968 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
4969 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
4970 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
4971 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
4975 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
4976 item itself, i.e.@: of the headline. You probably always should start the
4977 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
4978 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
4979 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
4980 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
4981 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
4982 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
4983 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
4984 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
4985 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
4986 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
4987 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
4990 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
4991 @subsection Using column view
4994 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
4995 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
4996 @vindex org-columns-default-format
4997 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
4998 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
4999 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5000 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5001 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5002 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5003 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5004 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5005 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5006 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5007 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5008 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5010 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5012 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5013 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5014 Move through the column view from field to field.
5015 @kindex S-@key{left}
5016 @kindex S-@key{right}
5017 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5018 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5019 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5021 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5022 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5023 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5024 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5025 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5026 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5027 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5028 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5029 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5030 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5031 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5032 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5033 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5034 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5035 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5036 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5037 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5038 current column view.
5039 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5040 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5041 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5042 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5043 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5044 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5045 Delete the current column.
5048 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5049 @subsection Capturing column view
5051 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5052 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5053 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5054 of this block looks like this:
5056 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5059 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5064 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5068 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5069 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5070 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5071 capture, you can use 4 values:
5072 @cindex property, ID
5074 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5075 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5076 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5077 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5078 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5079 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5080 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5081 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5084 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5085 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5087 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5089 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5090 @item :skip-empty-rows
5091 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5092 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5097 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5100 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5101 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5102 for the scope or ID of the view.
5103 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5104 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5105 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5106 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5107 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5108 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5112 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5113 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5114 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5115 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5117 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5118 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5119 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5120 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5121 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5122 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5123 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5125 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5126 @section The Property API
5127 @cindex properties, API
5128 @cindex API, for properties
5130 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5131 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5132 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5135 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5136 @chapter Dates and times
5142 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5143 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5144 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org-mode. This may be a
5145 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5146 something was created or last changed. However, in Org-mode this term
5147 is used in a much wider sense.
5150 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5151 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5152 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5153 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5154 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5155 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5156 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5160 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5161 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5163 @cindex ranges, time
5168 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5169 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
5170 @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
5171 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time
5172 format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A
5173 timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry.
5174 Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
5175 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5178 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5180 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5181 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5182 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5183 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5186 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5187 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5190 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5191 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5192 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5193 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5194 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5195 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5198 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5201 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5202 For more complex date specifications, Org-mode supports using the
5203 special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5204 package. For example
5207 * The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5208 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
5211 @item Time/Date range
5214 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5215 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5216 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5219 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5220 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5223 @item Inactive timestamp
5224 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5225 @cindex inactive timestamp
5226 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5227 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5228 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5231 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
5236 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5237 @section Creating timestamps
5238 @cindex creating timestamps
5239 @cindex timestamps, creating
5241 For Org-mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5242 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5246 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5247 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5248 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5249 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5250 succession, a time range is inserted.
5252 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5253 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5260 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5261 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5262 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5263 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5265 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5266 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5268 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5269 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5270 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5273 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5274 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5275 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5277 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5278 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5279 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5281 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5282 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5283 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5284 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5285 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5286 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5287 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5288 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5289 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5291 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5292 @cindex evaluate time range
5293 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5294 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5295 the following column).
5300 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
5301 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5304 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5305 @subsection The date/time prompt
5306 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5307 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5309 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5310 When Org-mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5311 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5312 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5313 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5314 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5315 copied from an email message. Org-mode will find whatever information is in
5316 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5317 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5318 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5319 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5320 information, Org-mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5321 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5322 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5323 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5324 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5325 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5326 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5328 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5329 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org-mode are
5333 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5334 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5335 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5336 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5337 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5338 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5339 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5340 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5341 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5342 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5343 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5344 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5345 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5346 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5349 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5350 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5351 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5352 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5353 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5354 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5355 the Nth such day. e.g.@:
5360 +4d @result{} four days from today
5361 +4 @result{} same as above
5362 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5363 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5364 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5367 @vindex parse-time-months
5368 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5369 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5370 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5371 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5373 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5374 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use `-' or `-@{@}-' as the separator
5375 in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter case. E.g.@:
5378 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5379 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5380 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5383 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5384 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5385 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5386 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5387 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5388 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5389 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5390 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5391 from the minibuffer:
5398 @kindex S-@key{right}
5399 @kindex S-@key{left}
5400 @kindex S-@key{down}
5402 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5403 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5406 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5407 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5408 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5409 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5410 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5411 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5412 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5415 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5416 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5417 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5418 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5419 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5420 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5421 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5423 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5424 @subsection Custom time format
5425 @cindex custom date/time format
5426 @cindex time format, custom
5427 @cindex date format, custom
5429 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5430 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5431 Org-mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5432 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5433 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5434 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5435 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5438 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5439 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5443 Org-mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5444 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5445 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5446 following consequences:
5449 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5452 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5453 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5454 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5455 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5456 time will be changed by one minute.
5458 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5459 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5461 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5462 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5463 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5465 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5466 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5467 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5471 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5472 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5474 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5478 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5480 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5481 to be finished on that date.
5483 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5484 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5485 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5486 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5487 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5488 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5491 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5492 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5493 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5496 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5497 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5498 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5501 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5503 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5506 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5507 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5508 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5509 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5510 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5511 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.@:
5512 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5515 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5516 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5520 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org-mode should @i{not} be
5521 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5522 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5523 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5524 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5525 Org users. In Org-mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5526 want to start working on an action item.
5529 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5530 entries. Org-mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5531 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5532 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5534 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
5536 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org-mode does not
5537 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5538 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5542 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5543 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5546 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5547 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5549 The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
5554 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5555 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5556 in the line directly following the headline. When called with a prefix arg,
5557 an existing deadline will be removed from the entry. Depending on the
5558 variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5559 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5560 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5562 @c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
5564 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5565 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5566 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5567 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5568 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5569 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5570 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5571 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5574 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5577 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5578 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5579 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5580 schedule the marked item.
5582 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5583 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5584 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5585 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5586 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5587 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5588 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5589 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5591 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5592 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5594 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5595 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5598 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5599 @subsection Repeated tasks
5600 @cindex tasks, repeated
5601 @cindex repeated tasks
5603 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org-mode helps to
5604 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5605 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5607 ** TODO Pay the rent
5608 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5611 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5612 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5613 from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
5614 a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
5615 @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5617 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5618 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5619 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5620 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5621 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5622 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5623 repeated entry will not be active. Org-mode deals with this in the following
5624 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5625 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5626 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5627 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5628 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5629 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5630 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5631 switch the date like this:
5634 ** TODO Pay the rent
5635 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5638 @vindex org-log-repeat
5639 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5640 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5641 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5642 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5643 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5645 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5646 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5649 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5650 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5651 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5652 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5653 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5654 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5655 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5656 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org-mode has
5657 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5661 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5662 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5663 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5664 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5665 and marked it done on Saturday.
5666 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5667 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5668 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5672 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5673 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5675 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5676 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5677 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5680 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5681 @section Clocking work time
5682 @cindex clocking time
5683 @cindex time clocking
5685 Org-mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5686 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
5687 When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
5688 clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
5689 also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
5690 remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly
5691 between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
5693 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
5695 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
5696 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
5698 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
5699 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
5700 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
5701 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
5705 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
5706 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
5707 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
5710 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
5711 @subsection Clocking commands
5714 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
5715 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
5716 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
5717 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
5718 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
5719 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
5720 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
5721 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
5722 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
5723 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
5724 with letter @kbd{d}.@*
5725 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
5726 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
5727 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
5728 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
5729 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
5730 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
5731 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
5732 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
5733 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
5734 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
5735 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
5736 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
5737 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
5738 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
5739 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
5740 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
5741 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
5742 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
5743 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
5745 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
5746 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
5747 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
5748 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
5749 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
5750 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
5751 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
5752 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
5753 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
5754 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
5755 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
5758 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5759 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
5760 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
5761 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
5762 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
5763 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
5764 if it is running in this same item.
5765 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-cancel}
5766 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
5767 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
5768 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
5769 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
5770 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
5771 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
5772 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
5773 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
5774 puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
5775 recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
5776 can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
5777 when you change the buffer (see variable
5778 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
5781 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
5782 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
5783 worked on or closed during a day.
5785 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
5786 @subsection The clock table
5787 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
5788 @cindex report, of clocked time
5790 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
5791 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
5792 formatted as one or several Org tables.
5795 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
5796 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
5797 report as an Org-mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
5798 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
5799 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
5801 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5802 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5803 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5804 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
5805 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5806 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
5807 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
5808 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
5809 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
5810 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
5814 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
5815 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
5817 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
5819 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
5823 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
5824 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
5825 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
5826 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
5828 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
5831 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
5832 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
5833 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
5834 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
5835 file @r{the full current buffer}
5836 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
5837 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
5838 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
5839 agenda @r{all agenda files}
5840 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
5841 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
5842 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
5843 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
5844 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
5846 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
5847 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
5848 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
5849 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
5850 2007 @r{the year 2007}
5851 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
5852 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
5853 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
5854 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
5855 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
5856 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
5857 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
5858 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
5859 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
5860 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
5861 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
5862 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute}.
5865 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
5866 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
5867 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
5869 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
5870 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
5871 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
5872 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
5873 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
5874 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
5875 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
5876 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
5877 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
5878 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
5879 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
5880 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
5881 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
5882 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
5883 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
5884 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
5885 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
5886 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
5887 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
5889 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
5890 day, you could write
5892 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
5896 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
5897 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
5898 only to fit it into the manual.}
5900 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
5901 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
5904 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
5906 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
5909 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
5912 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
5916 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
5917 @subsection Resolving idle time
5918 @cindex resolve idle time
5920 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
5921 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
5922 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
5923 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
5924 applying it to another one.
5926 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
5927 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
5928 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
5929 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
5930 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
5931 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
5932 UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
5933 treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
5934 only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
5935 question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
5936 passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
5937 choices to correct the discrepancy:
5941 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
5942 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
5943 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
5945 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
5946 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
5947 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
5949 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
5950 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
5952 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
5953 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
5954 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
5956 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
5957 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
5958 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
5959 log with an empty entry.
5962 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
5963 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
5964 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
5965 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
5966 the next task you clock in on.
5968 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
5969 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
5970 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
5971 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
5972 mode changes, including your last clock in.
5974 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
5975 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
5976 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
5977 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
5978 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it's just happening due
5979 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
5981 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
5982 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
5984 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
5985 @section Effort estimates
5986 @cindex effort estimates
5988 @cindex property, Effort
5989 @vindex org-effort-property
5990 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
5991 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
5992 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
5993 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
5994 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
5995 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
5996 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
5997 for an entry with the following commands:
6000 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6001 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6002 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6003 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6004 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6005 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6008 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6009 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6010 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6011 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6015 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
6016 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6020 @vindex org-global-properties
6021 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6022 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6023 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6024 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6025 setup may be advised.
6027 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6028 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6029 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6030 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6032 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6033 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6034 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6035 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6036 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6037 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6038 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6039 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6040 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6042 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6043 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6044 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6045 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6047 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6048 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6049 @cindex relative timer
6051 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6052 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6053 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6056 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6057 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6058 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6060 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6061 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6062 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6063 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6064 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6066 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6069 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6070 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6071 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6072 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6074 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6075 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6076 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6077 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6078 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6079 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6080 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6081 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6082 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6083 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6084 not started at exactly the right moment.
6087 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6088 @section Countdown timer
6089 @cindex Countdown timer
6093 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org-mode buffer runs a countdown
6094 timer. Use @key{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everwhere else.
6096 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6097 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6098 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6101 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6102 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6105 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6106 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6107 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6108 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6109 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6110 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6113 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6114 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6115 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6116 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6117 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6118 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6121 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6125 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6126 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6127 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org-mode for
6128 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6129 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6131 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6132 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6134 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6136 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6137 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6138 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6139 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6141 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6142 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6143 does enhance it with templates and more.
6146 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6147 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6148 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6151 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6152 @subsection Setting up capture
6154 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6155 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6156 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6158 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6160 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6161 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6164 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6165 @subsection Using capture
6168 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6169 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6170 not active by default - you need to install it. If you have templates
6172 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6173 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6174 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6175 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6177 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6178 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6179 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6180 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6181 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6183 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6184 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6185 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6186 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6187 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6188 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6189 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6191 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6192 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6196 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6197 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6198 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6199 rather than to the current date.
6201 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6206 Visit the target location of a cpature template. You get to select the
6207 template in the usual way.
6208 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6209 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6212 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6213 @subsection Capture templates
6214 @cindex templates, for Capture
6216 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6217 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6218 through the customize interface.
6222 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6225 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6226 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6227 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6228 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6229 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6233 (setq org-capture-templates
6234 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6235 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6236 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6237 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6240 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6244 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6248 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6249 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6250 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6251 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6252 place where you started the capture process.
6254 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6255 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6259 (define-key global-map "\C-c c"
6260 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture "t")))
6264 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6265 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6268 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6269 @subsubsection Template elements
6271 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6272 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6276 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6277 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6278 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6279 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6280 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6281 prefix key, for example
6283 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6285 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6286 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6289 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6293 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6296 An Org-mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the
6297 target entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org-mode
6300 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6301 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6303 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6306 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6307 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6308 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6310 Text to be inserted as it is.
6314 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6315 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org-mode
6316 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6317 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6318 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6319 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6320 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6324 @item (file "path/to/file")
6325 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6328 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of the file
6329 @code{org-capture} is called from.
6331 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6332 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6334 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6335 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6337 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6338 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6340 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6341 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6343 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6344 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6346 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6347 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6349 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6350 A function to find the right location in the file.
6353 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6355 @item (function function-finding-location)
6356 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6361 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6362 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6363 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6364 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6365 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6369 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6370 Recognized properties are:
6373 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6374 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6375 Setting this property will change that.
6377 @item :immediate-finish
6378 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6379 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6380 information that can be added automatically.
6383 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6384 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6387 Start the clock in this item.
6390 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6394 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6395 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6398 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6399 buffer again after capture is completed.
6403 @node Template expansion, , Template elements, Capture templates
6404 @subsubsection Template expansion
6406 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6407 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6408 dynamic insertion of content:
6410 @comment SJE: should these sentences terminate in period?
6412 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6413 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6414 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
6415 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6416 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
6417 %A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
6418 %i @r{initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6419 @r{region is active.}
6420 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6421 %t @r{timestamp, date only}
6422 %T @r{timestamp with date and time}
6423 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps}
6424 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
6425 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
6426 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
6427 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6428 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6429 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6430 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6431 %k @r{title of the currently clocked task}
6432 %K @r{link to the currently clocked task}
6433 %f @r{file visited by current buffer when org-capture was called}
6434 %F @r{like @code{%f}, but include full path}
6435 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6436 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6437 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}}
6438 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
6439 %[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}}
6440 %(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result}
6444 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6445 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6446 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6447 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6450 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6452 Link type | Available keywords
6453 -------------------+----------------------------------------------
6454 bbdb | %:name %:company
6455 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6456 vm, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6457 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6458 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6459 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6460 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6461 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6462 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6463 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6465 info | %:file %:node
6470 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6473 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6477 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6478 @section Attachments
6481 @vindex org-attach-directory
6482 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6483 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6484 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6485 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6486 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6487 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6488 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6489 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6490 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6491 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6492 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6493 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6494 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6496 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6497 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6498 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6501 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6505 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6506 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6507 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6508 to select a command:
6511 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6512 @vindex org-attach-method
6513 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6514 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6515 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6521 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6522 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6524 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6525 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6527 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6528 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6529 attachments yourself.
6531 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6532 @vindex org-file-apps
6533 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6534 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6535 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6536 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6538 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6539 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6541 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6542 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6544 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6545 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6547 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6548 Select and delete a single attachment.
6550 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6551 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6552 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6554 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6555 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6556 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6557 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6559 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6560 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6561 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6562 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6566 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6571 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6572 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6573 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6574 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6575 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6576 information. Here is just an example:
6579 (setq org-feed-alist
6581 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6582 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6586 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6587 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6588 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6589 the following command is used:
6592 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
6594 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6596 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
6597 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6600 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6601 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6602 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6603 list of drawers in that file:
6606 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
6609 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
6610 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
6612 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
6613 @section Protocols for external access
6614 @cindex protocols, for external access
6617 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
6618 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
6619 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
6620 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
6621 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
6622 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
6623 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
6624 documentation and setup instructions.
6626 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
6627 @section Refiling notes
6628 @cindex refiling notes
6630 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
6631 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
6632 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
6633 process, you can use the following special command:
6636 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
6637 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
6638 @vindex org-refile-targets
6639 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
6640 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
6641 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
6642 @vindex org-log-refile
6643 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
6644 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
6645 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
6646 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
6647 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
6649 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
6650 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
6651 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
6652 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
6653 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
6654 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
6655 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
6656 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
6657 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
6658 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
6659 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
6660 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
6661 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
6662 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
6663 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
6664 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
6666 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
6667 @item C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w
6669 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
6671 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
6672 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
6673 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
6676 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
6680 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
6681 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
6682 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
6683 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
6686 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
6687 @vindex org-archive-default-command
6688 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
6689 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
6693 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
6694 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
6697 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
6698 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
6699 @cindex external archiving
6701 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
6705 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
6706 @vindex org-archive-location
6707 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
6708 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
6709 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
6710 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
6711 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
6712 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
6713 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
6714 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
6717 @cindex archive locations
6718 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
6719 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
6720 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
6721 see the documentation string of the variable
6722 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
6723 setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
6724 the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
6725 each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
6726 such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
6727 using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
6728 with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
6729 setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
6733 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
6736 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
6738 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
6739 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
6740 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
6742 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
6743 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
6744 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
6745 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
6746 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
6750 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
6751 @subsection Internal archiving
6753 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
6754 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
6756 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
6757 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
6760 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
6761 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
6762 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
6763 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
6764 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
6765 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
6767 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
6768 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
6769 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
6770 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
6772 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
6773 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
6774 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
6775 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
6776 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
6777 temporarily included.
6779 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
6780 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
6781 is. Configure the details using the variable
6782 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
6784 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
6785 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
6786 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
6789 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
6792 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
6793 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
6794 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
6796 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
6797 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
6798 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
6799 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
6800 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
6801 level 1 trees will be checked.
6802 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
6803 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
6804 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
6805 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
6806 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
6807 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
6808 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
6813 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
6814 @chapter Agenda views
6815 @cindex agenda views
6817 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
6818 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
6819 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
6820 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
6821 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
6823 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
6824 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
6828 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
6831 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
6834 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
6835 TODO state associated with them,
6837 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
6838 in time-sorted view,
6840 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
6841 that contain specified keywords,
6843 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
6846 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
6851 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
6852 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
6853 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
6854 edit these files remotely.
6856 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
6857 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
6858 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
6859 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
6860 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
6861 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
6864 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
6865 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
6866 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
6867 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
6868 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
6869 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
6870 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
6871 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
6874 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
6875 @section Agenda files
6876 @cindex agenda files
6877 @cindex files for agenda
6879 @vindex org-agenda-files
6880 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
6881 files}, the files listed in the variable
6882 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
6883 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
6884 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
6885 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
6888 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
6889 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
6890 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
6891 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
6892 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
6893 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
6895 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
6897 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
6898 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
6899 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
6900 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
6901 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
6902 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
6904 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
6906 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
6907 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
6908 @item M-x org-iswitchb
6909 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
6914 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
6915 to visit any of them.
6917 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
6918 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
6919 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
6920 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
6921 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
6922 extended period, use the following commands:
6925 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
6926 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
6927 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
6928 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
6929 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
6930 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
6931 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
6932 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
6933 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
6937 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
6940 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
6941 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
6942 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
6943 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
6945 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
6946 Lift the restriction.
6949 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
6950 @section The agenda dispatcher
6951 @cindex agenda dispatcher
6952 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
6953 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
6954 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
6955 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
6956 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
6957 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
6958 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
6961 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
6963 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
6965 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
6966 tags and properties}).
6968 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
6970 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
6971 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
6973 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
6974 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
6975 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
6976 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
6977 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
6980 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
6982 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
6983 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
6984 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
6985 selecting the command.
6987 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
6988 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
6989 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
6990 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
6991 character selecting the command.
6994 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
6995 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
6996 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
6997 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
6998 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7000 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7001 @section The built-in agenda views
7003 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7006 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7007 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7008 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7009 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7010 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7011 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7014 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7015 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7017 @cindex weekly agenda
7018 @cindex daily agenda
7020 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7021 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7024 @cindex org-agenda, command
7025 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7026 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7027 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7028 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7029 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7030 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7031 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7034 @vindex org-agenda-span
7035 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7036 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7037 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7038 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7039 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7042 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7043 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7044 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7047 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7048 @cindex calendar integration
7049 @cindex diary integration
7051 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7052 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7053 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7054 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7055 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7056 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7059 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org-mode's
7060 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7063 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7066 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7067 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7068 agenda buffer created by Org-mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7069 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7070 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7071 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7072 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7073 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7074 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7075 between calendar and agenda.
7077 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7078 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7079 the entries into an Org file. Org-mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7080 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7081 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7082 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7083 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7084 will be made in the agenda:
7087 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7089 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7091 %%(diary-anniversary 5 14 1956)@footnote{Note that the order of the arguments (month, day, year) depends on the setting of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7092 %%(diary-anniversary 10 2 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7095 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7096 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7097 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7099 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7100 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7101 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7102 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7103 following to one your your agenda files:
7110 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7113 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7114 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7115 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7116 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7117 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7118 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7119 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7125 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org-mode, %d years ago
7128 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7129 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7130 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7131 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7132 in an Org or Diary file.
7134 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7135 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7136 @cindex appointment reminders
7138 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
7139 the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
7140 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
7141 list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
7142 or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
7144 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7145 @subsection The global TODO list
7146 @cindex global TODO list
7147 @cindex TODO list, global
7149 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7150 collected into a single place.
7153 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7154 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7155 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7156 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7157 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7158 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7159 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7160 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7161 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7162 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7163 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7164 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7165 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7166 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7168 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7169 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7170 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7171 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7172 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7173 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7176 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7177 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7178 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7180 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7181 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7182 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7186 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7187 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7188 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7189 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7190 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7191 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7192 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7193 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7194 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7195 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7198 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7199 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7200 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7201 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7202 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7205 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7206 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7207 @cindex matching, of tags
7208 @cindex matching, of properties
7212 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7213 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7214 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7215 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7219 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7220 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7221 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7222 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7223 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7224 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7225 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7226 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7227 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7228 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7229 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7230 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7231 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7232 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7236 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7239 @subsubheading Match syntax
7241 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7242 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7243 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7244 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7245 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7246 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7247 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7248 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7249 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7253 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7256 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7257 @item work|laptop+night
7258 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7262 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7263 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7264 braces. For example,
7265 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7266 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7268 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7269 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7270 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7271 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7272 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7273 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7274 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7275 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7276 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7277 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7278 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7279 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7280 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7282 Here are more examples:
7284 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7285 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7286 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7287 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7288 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7291 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7292 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7295 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7296 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7300 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7303 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7304 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7305 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7307 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7308 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7310 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7311 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7312 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7313 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7314 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7315 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e.@: without a time
7316 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7317 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7318 respectively, can be used.
7320 If the comparison value is enclosed
7321 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7322 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7326 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7327 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7328 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7329 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7330 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7331 on or after October 11, 2008.
7333 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7334 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7335 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7338 You can configure Org-mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7339 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7340 inheritance}, for details.
7342 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7343 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7344 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7345 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7346 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7347 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7348 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
7349 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7350 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7351 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7352 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7353 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7357 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7358 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7359 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7361 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7362 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7366 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7367 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7368 @cindex timeline, single file
7369 @cindex time-sorted view
7371 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org-mode
7372 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7373 to give an overview over events in a project.
7376 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7377 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7378 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7379 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7383 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7384 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7386 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7387 @subsection Search view
7390 @cindex searching, for text
7392 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org-mode entries.
7393 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7396 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7397 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7398 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7400 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7401 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7402 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7403 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7404 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7405 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7406 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7407 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7408 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7409 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7410 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7412 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7413 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7414 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7416 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7417 @subsection Stuck projects
7418 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7420 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7421 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7422 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7423 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7424 Org-mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7425 projects and define next actions for them.
7428 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7429 List projects that are stuck.
7432 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7433 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7434 project is and how to find it.
7437 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7438 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7439 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7440 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7442 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org-mode, identify
7443 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7444 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7445 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7446 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7447 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7448 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7449 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7450 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7451 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7452 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7453 correct customization for this is
7456 (setq org-stuck-projects
7457 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7461 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7462 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7464 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7465 @section Presentation and sorting
7466 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7468 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7469 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7470 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org-mode visually prepares the
7471 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7472 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7473 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7474 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7475 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7476 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7477 associated with the item.
7480 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7481 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7482 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7485 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7486 @subsection Categories
7490 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7491 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7492 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7493 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7494 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7495 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7496 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7497 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7498 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7506 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7507 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7508 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7509 special category you want to apply as the value.
7512 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7513 longer than 10 characters.
7516 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7517 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7519 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7520 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7521 @cindex time-of-day specification
7523 Org-mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7524 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7525 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7526 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7528 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7530 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7531 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7532 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7533 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7535 For agenda display, Org-mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7536 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7537 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7540 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7541 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7542 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7543 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7547 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7548 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7551 8:00...... ------------------
7552 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7553 10:00...... ------------------
7554 12:00...... ------------------
7555 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7556 14:00...... ------------------
7557 16:00...... ------------------
7558 18:00...... ------------------
7559 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7560 20:00...... ------------------
7561 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7564 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7565 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7566 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7567 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7568 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7570 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7571 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7572 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7573 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7574 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7575 done depends on the type of view.
7578 @vindex org-agenda-files
7579 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7580 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7581 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7582 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7583 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7584 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
7585 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
7586 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
7587 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
7589 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
7590 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
7591 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
7592 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
7595 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
7596 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
7599 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
7600 Sorting can be customized using the variable
7601 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
7602 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
7604 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
7605 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
7606 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
7608 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
7609 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
7610 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
7611 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
7612 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
7613 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
7615 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
7616 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
7619 @tsubheading{Motion}
7620 @cindex motion commands in agenda
7621 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
7622 Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
7623 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
7624 Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
7625 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
7626 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
7627 Display the original location of the item in another window.
7628 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
7629 outline, not only the heading.
7631 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
7632 Display original location and recenter that window.
7634 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
7635 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
7637 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
7638 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
7640 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
7641 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
7642 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
7643 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
7644 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
7645 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7646 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
7648 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
7649 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
7650 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
7651 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
7652 previously used indirect buffer.
7654 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
7655 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
7656 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
7657 will be followed without a selection prompt.
7659 @tsubheading{Change display}
7660 @cindex display changing, in agenda
7663 Delete other windows.
7665 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-aganda-day-view}
7666 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-aganda-day-view}
7667 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
7668 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-month-year}
7669 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
7670 @vindex org-agenda-span
7671 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
7672 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
7673 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
7674 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
7675 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
7676 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
7677 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
7678 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
7679 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
7680 1938-2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
7681 @code{org-agenda-span}.
7683 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
7684 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
7685 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
7686 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
7688 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
7689 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
7691 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
7694 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
7695 Prompt for a date and go there.
7697 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
7698 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
7700 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
7701 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
7703 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
7705 @vindex org-log-done
7706 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
7707 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
7708 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
7709 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
7710 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
7711 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
7712 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
7713 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
7714 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
7716 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
7717 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
7718 agenda and timeline views.
7720 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
7721 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
7722 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
7723 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
7724 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
7725 press @kbd{v a} again.
7727 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
7728 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
7729 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
7730 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
7731 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
7732 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7733 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
7734 when toggling this mode (i.e.@: @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
7735 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
7736 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}.
7738 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
7739 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
7740 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
7741 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
7742 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
7743 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
7744 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
7745 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
7747 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
7748 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7749 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7750 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
7751 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7753 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-rodo}
7754 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
7755 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
7756 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
7757 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
7759 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-rodo}
7762 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
7763 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
7766 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
7767 @vindex org-columns-default-format
7768 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
7769 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
7770 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
7771 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
7772 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
7773 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
7775 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7776 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
7777 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
7779 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
7780 @cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
7781 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
7782 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
7783 @cindex query editing, in agenda
7785 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
7786 @vindex org-agenda-filter-preset
7787 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
7788 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
7789 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
7790 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
7791 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-filter-preset} as an option. This
7792 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
7793 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
7794 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
7795 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
7797 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
7798 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
7799 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
7800 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
7801 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
7802 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
7803 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
7804 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
7805 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
7806 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
7808 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
7809 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
7810 efforts globally, for example
7812 (setq org-global-properties
7813 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
7815 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
7816 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
7817 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
7818 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
7819 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
7820 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
7821 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
7822 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
7823 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
7824 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
7826 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
7827 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
7828 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
7829 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
7830 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
7831 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
7832 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
7833 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
7834 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
7838 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
7840 ((string= tag "Net")
7841 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
7842 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
7843 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
7844 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
7845 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
7848 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
7852 @orgcmd{\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
7853 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
7854 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
7855 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
7856 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
7865 @item @r{in} search view
7866 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
7867 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
7868 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
7869 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
7870 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
7874 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
7875 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
7880 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
7881 @cindex remote editing, undo
7882 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
7883 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
7884 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
7886 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
7887 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
7890 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
7891 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
7892 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
7894 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
7895 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
7896 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
7897 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
7898 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
7899 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
7901 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
7902 Refile the entry at point.
7904 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
7905 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7906 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
7907 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
7908 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
7910 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
7911 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
7913 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
7914 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
7917 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
7918 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
7919 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
7922 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
7923 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
7924 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
7925 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
7926 tags of a headline occasionally.
7928 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
7929 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
7930 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
7934 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
7935 Org-mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the
7936 priority cookie is removed from the entry.
7938 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
7939 Display weighted priority of current item.
7941 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
7942 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
7943 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
7946 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
7947 Decrease the priority of the current item.
7949 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
7950 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
7951 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
7952 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
7953 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
7955 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
7956 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
7958 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
7959 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
7961 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
7962 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
7964 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-action}
7965 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
7966 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
7969 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
7970 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
7971 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
7972 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
7973 r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
7976 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
7979 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
7980 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
7981 future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
7982 example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a
7983 @kbd{C-u} prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the
7984 command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With
7985 a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp
7986 is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected
7987 in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
7989 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
7990 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
7993 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
7994 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
7995 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
7997 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
7998 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8001 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8002 Stop the previously started clock.
8004 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8005 Cancel the currently running clock.
8007 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8008 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8010 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8011 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8013 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8014 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8017 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8018 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8020 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8021 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8023 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8024 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8025 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8026 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8027 these special timestamps.
8029 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8030 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8031 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8032 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8033 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8034 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8035 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8036 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8037 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8038 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8039 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8040 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8041 S @r{Reschedule randomly by N days. N will be prompted for. With prefix}
8042 @r{arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only accross weekdays.}
8043 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8047 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8048 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8050 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8051 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8053 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8054 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org-mode agenda for the
8057 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8058 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8059 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8060 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8061 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8062 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8063 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8064 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8065 you can add the entry.
8067 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org-mode file,
8068 Org will create entries (in org-mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8069 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8070 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8071 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8072 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8073 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8074 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8075 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8076 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8078 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8079 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8081 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8082 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8083 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8085 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8086 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8089 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8090 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8092 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8093 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8094 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8096 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8097 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8098 @cindex exporting agenda views
8099 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8100 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8101 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8102 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8103 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8104 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8105 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8106 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8107 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8109 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8110 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8111 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8113 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8114 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8115 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8116 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8117 visit Org files will not be removed.
8121 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8122 @section Custom agenda views
8123 @cindex custom agenda views
8124 @cindex agenda views, custom
8126 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8127 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8128 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8129 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8132 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8133 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8134 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8137 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8138 @subsection Storing searches
8140 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8141 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8142 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8145 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8146 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8147 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8148 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
8149 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
8154 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8155 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8156 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8157 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8158 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8159 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8160 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8161 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8162 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8163 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8164 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8169 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8170 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8171 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8172 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8173 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8174 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8175 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8176 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8177 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8182 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8185 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8186 results as a sparse tree
8188 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8191 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8192 headlines that are also TODO items
8194 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8195 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8197 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8198 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8200 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8201 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8202 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8205 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8206 @subsection Block agenda
8207 @cindex block agenda
8208 @cindex agenda, with block views
8210 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8211 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8212 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8213 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8214 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8215 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8216 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8220 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8221 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8225 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8233 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8234 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8235 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8236 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8237 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8239 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8240 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8241 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8243 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8244 Org-mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8245 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8246 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8247 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8248 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8249 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8253 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8254 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8255 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8256 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8257 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8258 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8259 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8261 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8262 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8267 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8268 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8269 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8270 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8271 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8272 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8273 to only a single file.
8275 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8276 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8277 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8278 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8279 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8280 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8281 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8282 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8283 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8284 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8285 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8289 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8290 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8294 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8295 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8296 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8303 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8304 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8305 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8306 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8307 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8311 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8312 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8313 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8315 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8316 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org-mode can export custom
8317 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8318 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8319 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8320 a PDF file with also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8321 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8324 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8325 @cindex exporting agenda views
8326 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8327 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8328 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8329 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8330 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8331 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8332 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8333 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8335 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8336 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8337 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8338 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8340 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8341 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8342 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8343 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8344 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8348 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8349 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8350 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8351 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8352 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8353 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8354 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8355 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8356 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8361 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8362 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8363 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8364 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8369 ("~/views/home.html"))
8370 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8375 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8379 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8380 @file{.html}, Org-mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8381 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8382 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8383 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8384 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8385 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8386 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8388 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8389 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8390 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8394 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8395 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8399 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8400 set options for the export commands. For example:
8403 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8405 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8406 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8407 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8408 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8409 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8414 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8415 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8416 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8417 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8418 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8419 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8420 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8421 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8422 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8425 From the command line you may also use
8427 emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
8430 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8431 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8433 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8434 org-agenda-span month \
8435 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8436 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8437 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8441 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8442 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8445 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8446 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8450 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8451 @section Using column view in the agenda
8452 @cindex column view, in agenda
8453 @cindex agenda, column view
8455 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8456 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8457 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8458 collected by certain criteria.
8461 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8462 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8465 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8466 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8467 This causes the following issues:
8471 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8472 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8473 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8474 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8475 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8476 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
8477 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8478 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8479 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8480 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8482 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8483 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8484 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8485 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8486 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8487 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8488 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8489 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8490 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8491 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8492 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8493 some values will count double.
8495 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8496 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8497 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8498 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8499 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8500 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8501 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8506 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
8507 @chapter Markup for rich export
8509 When exporting Org-mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
8510 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
8511 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
8512 Org-mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
8513 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org-mode buffer.
8516 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
8517 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
8518 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
8519 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
8520 * Index entries:: Making an index
8521 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
8522 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
8525 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
8526 @section Structural markup elements
8529 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
8530 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
8531 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
8532 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
8534 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
8535 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
8536 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
8537 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
8538 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
8541 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
8542 @subheading Document title
8543 @cindex document title, markup rules
8546 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
8550 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
8554 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
8555 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
8556 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
8557 title will be the file name without extension.
8559 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
8560 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
8561 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
8562 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
8564 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
8565 @subheading Headings and sections
8566 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
8568 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
8569 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
8570 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
8571 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
8572 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
8573 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
8574 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
8575 per-file basis with a line
8582 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
8583 @subheading Table of contents
8584 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
8586 @vindex org-export-with-toc
8587 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
8588 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
8589 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
8590 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
8591 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
8592 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
8593 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
8596 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
8597 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
8600 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
8601 @subheading Text before the first headline
8602 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
8605 Org-mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
8606 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
8607 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
8608 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
8610 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
8611 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
8612 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
8613 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
8614 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
8615 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
8618 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
8619 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
8623 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
8624 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
8625 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
8628 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
8630 @cindex lists, markup rules
8632 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
8633 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
8636 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
8637 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
8638 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
8640 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
8641 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
8643 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
8644 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
8646 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
8649 Great clouds overhead
8650 Tiny black birds rise and fall
8657 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
8658 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
8659 can include quotations in Org-mode documents like this:
8661 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8664 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
8665 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
8669 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
8670 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
8673 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
8679 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
8680 @subheading Footnote markup
8681 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
8682 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
8684 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported by
8685 all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
8686 different backends support this to varying degrees.
8688 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
8689 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
8691 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
8692 @cindex bold text, markup rules
8693 @cindex italic text, markup rules
8694 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
8695 @cindex code text, markup rules
8696 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
8697 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
8698 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
8699 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org-mode specific
8700 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
8702 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
8703 @subheading Horizontal rules
8704 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
8705 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
8706 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
8708 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
8709 @subheading Comment lines
8710 @cindex comment lines
8711 @cindex exporting, not
8712 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
8714 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
8715 never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
8716 start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
8717 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
8718 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
8723 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
8727 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
8728 @section Images and Tables
8730 @cindex tables, markup rules
8733 Both the native Org-mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
8734 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org-mode tables,
8735 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
8736 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
8737 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
8738 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
8741 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
8742 #+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
8747 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
8748 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
8749 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
8750 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
8751 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
8752 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
8753 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
8756 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
8757 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
8761 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
8762 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
8765 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
8767 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
8768 @section Literal examples
8769 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
8770 @cindex code line references, markup rules
8772 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
8773 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
8774 for source code and similar examples.
8775 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8779 Some example from a text file.
8783 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
8784 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
8785 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
8786 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
8787 whitespace before the colon:
8791 : Some example from a text file.
8794 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
8795 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
8796 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
8797 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
8798 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
8799 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in LaTeX can be
8800 achieved using either the listings or the
8801 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. To use listings, turn
8802 on the variable @code{org-export-latex-listings} and ensure that the listings
8803 package is included by the LaTeX header (e.g.@: by configuring
8804 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}). See the listings documentation for
8805 configuration options, including obtaining colored output. For minted it is
8806 necessary to install the program @url{http://pygments.org, pygments}, in
8807 addition to setting @code{org-export-latex-minted}, ensuring that the minted
8808 package is included by the LaTeX header, and ensuring that the
8809 @code{-shell-escape} option is passed to @file{pdflatex} (see
8810 @code{org-latex-to-pdf-process}). See the documentation of the variables
8811 @code{org-export-latex-listings} and @code{org-export-latex-minted} for
8812 further details.}. This is done with the @samp{src} block, where you also
8813 need to specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the
8818 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
8819 (defun org-xor (a b)
8825 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
8826 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
8827 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
8828 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
8829 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
8830 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e.@: the reference name
8831 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
8832 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
8835 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
8836 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
8837 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
8838 be useful to explain those in an org-mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
8839 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
8840 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
8844 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
8845 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
8846 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
8848 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
8852 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
8853 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
8854 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
8855 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
8857 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas, @xref{Text
8858 areas in HTML export}.
8863 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
8864 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
8865 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
8866 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
8867 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
8868 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}. The edited version will
8869 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
8870 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
8871 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
8872 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
8873 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
8877 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
8878 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
8879 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
8880 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
8881 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
8885 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
8886 @section Include files
8887 @cindex include files, markup rules
8889 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
8890 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
8894 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
8897 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g.@: @samp{quote},
8898 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
8899 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
8900 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org-mode format and will be
8901 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
8902 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
8903 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
8904 org-mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
8905 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
8909 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
8912 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
8913 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
8914 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
8918 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
8919 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
8920 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
8926 Visit the include file at point.
8929 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
8930 @section Index entries
8931 @cindex index entries, for publishing
8933 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
8934 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
8935 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
8936 an index} for more information.
8941 #+INDEX: Application!CV
8947 @node Macro replacement, Embedded LaTeX, Index entries, Markup
8948 @section Macro replacement
8949 @cindex macro replacement, during export
8952 You can define text snippets with
8955 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
8958 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
8959 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
8960 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
8961 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
8962 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
8963 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
8964 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
8965 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
8966 @code{format-time-string}.
8968 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
8969 construct complex HTML code.
8972 @node Embedded LaTeX, , Macro replacement, Markup
8973 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
8974 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
8975 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
8977 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
8978 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
8979 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
8980 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
8981 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
8982 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org-mode
8983 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
8984 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
8985 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
8988 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
8989 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
8990 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
8991 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
8992 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
8995 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
8996 @subsection Special symbols
8997 @cindex math symbols
8998 @cindex special symbols
8999 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9000 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9001 @cindex HTML entities
9002 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9004 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9005 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9006 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9007 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9008 code, Org-mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9009 delimiters, for example:
9012 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9015 @vindex org-entities
9016 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9017 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9018 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9019 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
9020 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9021 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9023 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9024 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9025 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9026 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9027 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9029 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9030 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9031 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9032 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9037 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9038 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9039 for display purposes only.
9042 @node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Special symbols, Embedded LaTeX
9043 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9047 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9048 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9049 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9050 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9051 with curly braces. For example
9054 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9055 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9058 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9059 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9060 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9061 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9062 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9063 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9064 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9070 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9071 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9076 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9077 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9080 @node LaTeX fragments, Previewing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
9081 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9082 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9084 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9085 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9086 needed. Org-mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9087 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9088 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9089 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9090 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9091 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9092 @file{MathJax} on your own
9093 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9094 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9095 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9096 need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
9097 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The @LaTeX{} header that will
9098 be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9099 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9102 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9103 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9106 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9107 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9108 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9109 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9110 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9112 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9113 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9114 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9115 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9116 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9117 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9118 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9121 @noindent For example:
9124 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9125 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9126 \end@{equation@} % etc
9128 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9129 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9133 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9134 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9135 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9136 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9138 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9139 LaTeX processing can be configured with the variable
9140 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9141 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9142 LaTeX backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9146 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9147 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9148 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9149 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9152 @node Previewing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
9153 @subsection Previewing LaTeX fragments
9154 @cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
9156 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9157 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9162 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9163 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9164 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9165 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9166 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9167 process the entire buffer.
9170 Remove the overlay preview images.
9173 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9174 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9175 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9176 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9179 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
9180 @subsection Using CDLa@TeX{} to enter math
9183 CDLa@TeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9184 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9185 environments and math templates. Inside Org-mode, you can make use of
9186 some of the features of CDLa@TeX{} mode. You need to install
9187 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9188 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9189 Don't use CDLa@TeX{} mode itself under Org-mode, but use the light
9190 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org-mode. Turn it
9191 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9195 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9198 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9199 details see the documentation of CDLa@TeX{} mode):
9203 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9206 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9207 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org-mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9208 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9209 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9210 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9211 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9212 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9213 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9214 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9215 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9216 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9220 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9221 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9222 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9223 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9224 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9225 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9228 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9229 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9230 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9233 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9234 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9235 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9236 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9240 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9244 Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9245 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9246 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9247 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9248 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org-mode and
9249 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9250 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9251 DocBook tools. For project management you can create gantt and resource
9252 charts by using TaskJuggler export. To incorporate entries with associated
9253 times like deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar program like
9254 iCal, Org-mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently
9255 Org-mode only supports export, not import of these different formats.
9257 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9258 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9261 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9262 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9263 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9264 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9265 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9266 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9267 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9268 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9269 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9270 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9271 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9274 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9275 @section Selective export
9276 @cindex export, selective by tags
9278 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9279 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9280 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9281 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9282 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
9284 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
9285 If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
9286 selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
9287 selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9290 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9294 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9295 be removed from the export buffer.
9297 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9298 @section Export options
9299 @cindex options, for export
9301 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9302 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9303 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9304 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9305 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9306 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9307 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9308 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9309 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9310 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9313 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9314 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9321 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9329 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9330 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9332 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9333 @vindex user-full-name
9334 @vindex user-mail-address
9335 @vindex org-export-default-language
9337 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9338 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9339 #+DATE: a date, fixed, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9340 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9341 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9342 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9343 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g.@: @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9344 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9345 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9346 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9347 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.@:: org-export-latex-low-levels itemize
9348 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9349 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9350 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9351 #+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the LaTeX header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9352 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9353 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9354 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9358 The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9359 this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export
9360 settings. Here you can:
9361 @cindex headline levels
9362 @cindex section-numbers
9363 @cindex table of contents
9364 @cindex line-break preservation
9365 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9366 @cindex fixed-width sections
9368 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9370 @cindex special strings
9371 @cindex emphasized text
9372 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9373 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9374 @cindex author info, in export
9375 @cindex time info, in export
9377 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9378 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9379 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9380 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9381 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9382 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9383 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9384 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9385 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9386 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9387 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9388 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9389 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9390 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9391 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9392 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9393 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9394 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9395 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9396 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9397 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9398 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9399 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9400 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9401 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
9404 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9405 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and @code{nil}
9406 for the @LaTeX{} export. The default values for these and many other options
9407 are given by a set of variables. For a list of such variables, the
9408 corresponding OPTIONS keys and also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project
9409 alist}), see the constant @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9411 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9412 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9413 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9414 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9415 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9417 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9418 @section The export dispatcher
9419 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9421 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9422 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9423 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9424 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9425 the subtrees are exported.
9428 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9429 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9430 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9431 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9432 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9433 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9434 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9435 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9436 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9437 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9438 (i.e.@: not hidden by outline visibility).
9439 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9440 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9441 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9442 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e.@: request background processing if
9443 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9446 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9447 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9448 @cindex ASCII export
9449 @cindex Latin-1 export
9450 @cindex UTF-8 export
9452 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode
9453 file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9454 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9456 @cindex region, active
9457 @cindex active region
9458 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9460 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9461 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9462 Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9463 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9464 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9465 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9466 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9467 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9468 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9469 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9471 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
9472 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9473 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
9474 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
9475 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
9476 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
9477 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
9478 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
9479 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
9480 Export only the visible part of the document.
9483 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9484 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9485 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9486 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
9487 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
9494 creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
9495 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
9496 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
9497 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
9498 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
9499 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
9500 indentation than the first, these are left alone.
9502 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
9503 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
9504 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
9505 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
9507 @node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
9508 @section HTML export
9511 Org-mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
9512 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
9513 language, but with additional support for tables.
9516 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
9517 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
9518 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
9519 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
9520 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
9521 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
9522 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
9523 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
9524 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
9527 @node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
9528 @subsection HTML export commands
9530 @cindex region, active
9531 @cindex active region
9532 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9534 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
9535 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9536 Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
9537 the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
9538 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9539 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9540 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9541 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9542 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9543 property, that name will be used for the export.
9544 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
9545 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
9546 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
9547 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9548 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
9549 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
9550 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
9551 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
9552 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
9553 Export only the visible part of the document.
9554 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
9555 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9556 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9558 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
9559 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by HTML
9563 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9564 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
9565 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
9566 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
9567 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9574 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9576 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML Export commands, HTML export
9577 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
9579 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
9580 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
9581 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
9582 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
9583 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
9584 the exported file use either
9587 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9589 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
9593 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9597 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9602 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
9603 @subsection Links in HTML export
9605 @cindex links, in HTML export
9606 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
9607 @cindex external links, in HTML export
9608 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
9609 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
9610 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
9611 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
9612 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
9613 that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
9614 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
9615 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
9616 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
9618 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
9619 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
9620 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
9621 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
9625 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org-mode homepage" style="color:red;"
9626 [[http://orgmode.org]]
9629 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
9631 @cindex tables, in HTML
9632 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
9634 Org-mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
9635 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
9636 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
9637 tables, place something like the following before the table:
9642 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
9643 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="all"
9646 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
9647 @subsection Images in HTML export
9649 @cindex images, inline in HTML
9650 @cindex inlining images in HTML
9651 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
9652 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
9653 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
9654 default@footnote{But see the variable
9655 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
9656 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
9657 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
9658 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
9659 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
9660 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
9661 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
9662 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
9665 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
9668 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
9669 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
9670 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
9675 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
9676 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
9681 and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
9683 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
9684 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
9688 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{LaTeX fragments}) can be displayed in two
9689 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
9690 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
9691 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
9692 @file{MathJax} for Org-mode users for small applications and for testing
9693 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
9694 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
9695 found on the MathJax website, see
9696 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
9697 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
9698 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
9699 insert something like the following into the buffer:
9702 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
9705 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
9706 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
9709 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
9710 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
9711 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
9712 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
9713 You can still get this processing with
9716 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
9719 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
9720 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
9722 @cindex text areas, in HTML
9723 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
9724 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
9725 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
9726 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
9727 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
9728 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
9729 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
9730 respectively. For example
9733 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
9734 (defun org-xor (a b)
9741 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
9742 @subsection CSS support
9743 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
9744 @cindex HTML export, CSS
9746 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
9747 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
9748 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
9749 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
9750 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
9751 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
9752 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
9753 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
9754 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
9756 p.author @r{author information, including email}
9757 p.date @r{publishing date}
9758 p.creator @r{creator info, about org-mode version}
9759 .title @r{document title}
9760 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
9761 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
9762 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
9763 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
9764 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
9765 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
9766 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
9767 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
9768 .target @r{target for links}
9769 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
9770 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
9771 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
9772 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
9773 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
9774 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
9775 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
9776 pre.example @r{normal example}
9777 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
9778 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
9779 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
9780 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
9781 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
9784 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9785 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
9786 @vindex org-export-html-style
9787 @vindex org-export-html-extra
9788 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9789 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
9790 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
9791 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
9792 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
9793 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
9794 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
9795 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
9796 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
9797 individually for each file, you can use
9801 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
9805 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
9806 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
9807 referring to an external file.
9809 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
9810 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
9811 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
9814 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
9815 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
9817 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
9818 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
9820 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
9821 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
9822 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
9823 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
9824 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
9825 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
9826 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
9827 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
9828 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
9829 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
9830 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
9831 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
9832 copy on your own web server.
9834 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
9835 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
9836 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
9837 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
9838 adding a single line to the Org file:
9840 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
9842 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
9846 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
9847 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
9851 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
9852 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
9853 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
9854 view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
9855 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
9856 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
9857 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
9858 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
9859 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
9860 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
9861 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
9862 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
9863 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
9864 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
9865 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
9866 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
9867 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
9868 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
9869 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
9870 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
9871 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
9872 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
9873 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
9874 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
9875 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
9878 @vindex org-infojs-options
9879 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
9880 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
9881 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
9882 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
9884 @node LaTeX and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
9885 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
9886 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
9888 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
9890 Org-mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
9891 further processing@footnote{The default LaTeX output is designed for
9892 processing with pdftex or latex. It includes packages that are not
9893 compatible with xetex and possibly luatex. See the variables
9894 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9895 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
9896 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
9897 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
9901 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
9902 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
9903 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
9904 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
9905 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
9906 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
9909 @node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
9910 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
9912 @cindex region, active
9913 @cindex active region
9914 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9916 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
9917 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9918 Export as @LaTeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an Org file
9919 @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
9920 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
9921 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9922 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9923 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9924 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9925 property, that name will be used for the export.
9926 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
9927 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9929 Export only the visible part of the document.
9930 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
9931 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9932 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9934 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
9935 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
9937 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
9938 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
9939 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
9940 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
9943 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9944 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
9945 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9946 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9947 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
9948 convert them to a custom string depending on
9949 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
9951 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
9952 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9959 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9961 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
9962 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
9963 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
9964 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
9965 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
9966 @cindex header, for LaTeX files
9967 @cindex sectioning structure, for LaTeX export
9969 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
9971 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
9972 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
9973 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
9974 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
9975 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9976 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
9977 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9978 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS
9979 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9980 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
9981 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
9982 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
9983 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
9984 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
9985 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
9986 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
9987 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
9988 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
9989 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS}
9990 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. You
9991 can also use @code{#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}} to add lines to the
9992 header. See the docstring of @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more
9995 @node Quoting LaTeX code, Tables in LaTeX export, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export
9996 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
9998 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX}, will be correctly
9999 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10000 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10001 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10002 the following constructs:
10005 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10007 #+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
10011 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10015 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10020 @node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
10021 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10022 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10024 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
10025 (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
10026 request a @code{longtable} environment for the table, so that it may span
10027 several pages, or to change the default table environment from @code{table}
10028 to @code{table*} or to change the default inner tabular environment to
10029 @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can set the alignment
10030 string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the width:
10034 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10036 #+CAPTION: A long table
10038 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10043 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10047 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10049 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10051 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10056 @node Images in LaTeX export, Beamer class export, Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
10057 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10058 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10059 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10061 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10062 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10063 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10064 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10065 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10066 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10067 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the various
10068 options that can be used in the optional argument of the
10069 @code{\includegraphics} macro. To modify the placement option of the
10070 @code{figure} environment, add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the
10073 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10074 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10075 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10076 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10077 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10078 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10082 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10084 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10085 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10086 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10087 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10089 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10093 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10094 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10096 @node Beamer class export, , Images in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
10097 @subsection Beamer class export
10099 The LaTeX class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10100 using LaTeX and pdf processing. Org-mode has special support for turning an
10101 Org-mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10103 When the LaTeX class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10104 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10105 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10106 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10107 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10108 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10109 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10110 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10111 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10112 structure of the presentation.
10114 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10115 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10116 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10117 editing special properties used by beamer.
10119 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10124 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10125 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10126 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10127 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10128 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10129 @item BEAMER_envargs
10130 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10131 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10132 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10133 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10134 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10137 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10138 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10139 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10140 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10141 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10142 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10143 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10144 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10146 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10147 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10151 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10152 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10153 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10154 @code{#+BEGIN_beamer...#+end_beamer} constructs, similar to other export
10155 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10156 in the presentation as well.
10158 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10159 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10160 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10161 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10162 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10163 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10164 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10166 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10174 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10175 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10176 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10179 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10180 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10181 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10182 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10184 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10187 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10188 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10189 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10190 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10191 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10192 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10193 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10195 * This is the first structural section
10197 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10198 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10201 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10204 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10205 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10209 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10211 for contributing to the discussion
10212 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10213 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10214 *** Request :B_block:
10215 Please test this stuff!
10221 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10223 @node DocBook export, TaskJuggler export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
10224 @section DocBook export
10225 @cindex DocBook export
10227 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10229 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10230 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10231 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10232 tools and stylesheets.
10234 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10237 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10238 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10239 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10240 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10241 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10242 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10245 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10246 @subsection DocBook export commands
10248 @cindex region, active
10249 @cindex active region
10250 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10252 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10253 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10254 Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10255 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10256 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10257 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10258 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10259 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10260 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10261 property, that name will be used for the export.
10262 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10263 Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10265 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10266 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10267 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
10268 need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10269 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10270 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10272 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10273 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10274 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10275 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10276 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10277 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10279 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10280 Export only the visible part of the document.
10283 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10284 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10286 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10287 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10290 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10292 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10296 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10300 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10305 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10306 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10307 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10308 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10313 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10314 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10315 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10320 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10321 @subsection Recursive sections
10322 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10324 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10325 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e.@: @code{section} elements, are
10326 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10327 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10328 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10329 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10331 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10332 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10334 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10335 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10336 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10338 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10341 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10342 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10343 using the @code{table} element.
10345 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10346 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10347 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10348 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10350 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10351 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10352 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10353 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10354 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10355 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10356 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10357 @code{mediaobject} element.
10359 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10360 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10361 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10362 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10363 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10364 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10365 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10366 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10368 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10369 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10370 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10371 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10372 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10377 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10379 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org-mode
10380 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10381 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10382 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10385 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10386 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10387 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10388 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10389 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10391 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10392 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10393 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10395 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10396 @vindex org-entities
10397 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10398 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10399 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
10400 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
10401 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10402 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10404 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10405 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10406 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10407 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10410 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10411 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
10412 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
10413 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
10420 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, DocBook export, Exporting
10421 @section TaskJuggler export
10422 @cindex TaskJuggler export
10423 @cindex Project management
10425 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
10426 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
10427 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
10430 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
10431 HTML and LaTeX exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
10432 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
10435 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
10436 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
10437 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
10440 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
10443 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
10444 Export as TaskJuggler file.
10446 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
10447 Export as TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
10452 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
10453 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org-mode. Assign efforts to each
10454 task using properties (it's easiest to do this in the column view). You
10455 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
10456 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
10457 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
10458 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
10459 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
10460 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
10461 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
10463 @subsection Resources
10465 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
10466 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
10467 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
10468 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
10469 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
10470 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
10471 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
10472 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
10473 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
10474 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
10475 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
10476 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
10477 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
10479 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
10480 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
10483 @subsection Export of properties
10485 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e.@: if a
10486 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
10487 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
10488 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
10489 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
10490 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
10491 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
10492 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
10493 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
10495 @subsection Dependencies
10497 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
10498 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
10499 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
10500 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
10501 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
10502 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
10503 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
10504 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
10505 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
10506 examples should illustrate this:
10511 :task_id: preparation
10514 * Training material
10516 :task_id: training_material
10519 ** Markup Guidelines
10523 ** Workflow Guidelines
10530 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
10534 @subsection Reports
10536 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
10537 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g.@: gantt chart, resource
10538 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
10539 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
10540 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
10541 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
10542 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
10543 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
10545 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
10546 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
10548 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
10549 @section Freemind export
10550 @cindex Freemind export
10553 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
10556 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
10557 Export as Freemind mind map @file{myfile.mm}.
10560 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
10561 @section XOXO export
10562 @cindex XOXO export
10564 Org-mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
10565 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
10566 does not interpret any additional Org-mode features.
10569 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
10570 Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
10571 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
10572 Export only the visible part of the document.
10575 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
10576 @section iCalendar export
10577 @cindex iCalendar export
10579 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
10580 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
10581 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
10582 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
10583 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
10584 Some people use Org-mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
10585 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
10586 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
10587 files in the calendar application. Org-mode can export calendar information
10588 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
10589 included in the export, configure the variable
10590 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
10591 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
10592 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
10593 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
10594 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
10595 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
10596 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
10597 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
10598 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
10601 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
10602 @cindex property, ID
10603 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
10604 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
10605 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
10606 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
10607 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
10608 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
10609 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
10610 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
10611 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
10614 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
10615 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
10616 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
10617 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
10618 @vindex org-agenda-files
10619 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
10620 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
10621 file will be written.
10622 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
10623 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
10624 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
10625 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
10626 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
10629 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
10630 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
10631 @cindex property, SUMMARY
10632 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
10633 @cindex property, LOCATION
10634 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
10635 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
10636 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
10637 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
10638 and the description from the body (limited to
10639 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
10641 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
10642 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
10644 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
10645 @chapter Publishing
10648 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
10649 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
10650 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
10651 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
10654 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
10655 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
10657 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
10660 * Configuration:: Defining projects
10661 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
10662 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
10663 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
10666 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
10667 @section Configuration
10669 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
10670 and many other properties of a project.
10673 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
10674 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
10675 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
10676 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
10677 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
10678 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
10679 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
10680 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
10683 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
10684 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
10685 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
10686 @cindex projects, for publishing
10688 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10689 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
10690 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
10691 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
10694 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
10695 @r{i.e.@: a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
10697 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
10701 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
10702 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
10703 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
10704 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
10705 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
10706 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
10707 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
10710 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
10711 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
10712 @cindex directories, for publishing
10714 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
10715 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
10716 and where to put published files.
10718 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10719 @item @code{:base-directory}
10720 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
10721 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
10722 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
10723 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
10724 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
10725 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
10726 @item @code{:preparation-function}
10727 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
10728 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
10729 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
10730 variable @code{project-plist}.
10731 @item @code{:completion-function}
10732 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
10733 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
10734 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
10735 @code{project-plist}.
10739 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
10740 @subsection Selecting files
10741 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
10743 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
10744 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
10746 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10747 @item @code{:base-extension}
10748 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
10749 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
10750 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
10752 @item @code{:exclude}
10753 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
10754 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
10757 @item @code{:include}
10758 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
10759 and @code{:exclude}.
10761 @item @code{:recursive}
10762 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
10765 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
10766 @subsection Publishing action
10767 @cindex action, for publishing
10769 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
10770 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
10771 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
10772 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
10773 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
10774 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
10775 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
10776 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
10777 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
10778 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
10779 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
10780 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
10781 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
10782 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
10783 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
10784 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
10785 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
10786 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
10787 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
10789 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10790 @item @code{:publishing-function}
10791 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
10792 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
10793 @item @code{:plain-source}
10794 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
10795 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
10796 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
10799 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
10800 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
10801 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
10802 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
10803 and place the result into the destination folder.
10805 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
10806 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
10807 @cindex options, for publishing
10809 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
10810 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
10811 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
10812 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
10813 respective variable for details.
10815 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
10816 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
10817 @vindex org-export-default-language
10818 @vindex org-display-custom-times
10819 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
10820 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
10821 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
10822 @vindex org-export-with-toc
10823 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
10824 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
10825 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
10826 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
10827 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
10828 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
10829 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
10830 @vindex org-export-with-tags
10831 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
10832 @vindex org-export-with-priority
10833 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
10834 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
10835 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
10836 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
10837 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
10838 @vindex org-export-author-info
10839 @vindex org-export-email
10840 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10841 @vindex org-export-with-tables
10842 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
10843 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10844 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
10845 @vindex org-export-html-style
10846 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
10847 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
10848 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10849 @vindex org-export-html-extension
10850 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10851 @vindex org-export-html-expand
10852 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
10853 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
10854 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10855 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10856 @vindex user-full-name
10857 @vindex user-mail-address
10858 @vindex org-export-select-tags
10859 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
10861 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
10862 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
10863 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
10864 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
10865 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
10866 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
10867 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
10868 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
10869 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
10870 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
10871 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
10872 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
10873 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
10874 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
10875 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
10876 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
10877 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
10878 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
10879 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
10880 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
10881 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
10882 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
10883 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
10884 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
10885 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
10886 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
10887 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
10888 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
10889 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
10890 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
10891 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
10892 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
10893 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
10894 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
10895 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
10896 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
10897 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
10898 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
10899 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
10900 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
10901 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
10902 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
10903 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
10904 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
10905 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
10906 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
10907 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
10908 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
10909 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
10912 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
10913 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
10914 @code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
10917 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10918 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
10919 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
10920 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
10921 options}), however, override everything.
10923 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
10924 @subsection Links between published files
10925 @cindex links, publishing
10927 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
10928 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
10929 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
10930 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
10931 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
10932 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
10933 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
10934 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
10937 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
10938 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
10939 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
10940 an example of this usage.
10942 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
10943 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
10944 location. In this case, use the property
10946 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
10947 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
10948 @tab Function to validate links
10952 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
10953 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
10954 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
10955 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
10956 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
10957 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
10958 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
10960 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
10961 @subsection Generating a sitemap
10962 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
10964 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
10965 a map of files for a given project.
10967 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
10968 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
10969 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
10970 or @code{org-publish-all}.
10972 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
10973 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
10974 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
10976 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
10977 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
10979 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
10980 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
10981 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
10982 of links to all files in the project.
10984 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
10985 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
10986 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
10987 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
10989 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
10990 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
10991 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
10992 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
10993 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
10994 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
10995 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
10997 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
10998 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
11000 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
11001 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formated in the
11002 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
11003 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
11004 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
11005 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formated with
11006 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
11008 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
11009 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
11010 a sitemap entry's date is to be formated. This property bypasses
11011 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
11015 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
11016 @subsection Generating an index
11017 @cindex index, in a publishing project
11019 Org-mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
11021 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
11022 @item @code{:makeindex}
11023 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
11024 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
11027 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
11028 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+include:
11029 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
11030 a title, style information, etc.
11032 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
11033 @section Uploading files
11037 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
11038 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
11039 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org-mode which rely heavily on
11040 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
11041 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
11044 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
11045 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
11046 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
11047 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
11048 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
11050 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
11051 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
11052 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
11053 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
11054 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
11055 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
11058 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
11059 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
11060 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
11061 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
11062 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
11063 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
11065 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
11066 @section Sample configuration
11068 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
11069 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
11070 more complex, with a multi-component project.
11073 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
11074 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
11077 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
11078 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
11080 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
11081 directory on the local machine.
11084 (setq org-publish-project-alist
11086 :base-directory "~/org/"
11087 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
11088 :section-numbers nil
11089 :table-of-contents nil
11090 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
11091 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
11092 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
11095 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
11096 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
11098 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
11099 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
11100 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
11103 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
11104 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
11105 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
11106 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
11109 file:../images/myimage.png
11112 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
11113 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
11114 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
11117 (setq org-publish-project-alist
11119 :base-directory "~/org/"
11120 :base-extension "org"
11121 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
11122 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
11123 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
11125 :section-numbers nil
11126 :table-of-contents nil
11127 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
11128 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
11132 :base-directory "~/images/"
11133 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
11134 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
11135 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
11138 :base-directory "~/other/"
11139 :base-extension "css\\|el"
11140 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
11141 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
11142 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
11145 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
11146 @section Triggering publication
11148 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
11151 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
11152 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
11153 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
11154 Publish the project containing the current file.
11155 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
11156 Publish only the current file.
11157 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
11158 Publish every project.
11161 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
11162 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
11163 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
11164 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
11165 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
11166 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
11167 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
11169 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11170 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
11172 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
11173 @chapter Working with source code
11174 @cindex Schulte, Eric
11175 @cindex Davison, Dan
11176 @cindex source code, working with
11178 Source code can be included in Org-mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
11182 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
11183 (defun org-xor (a b)
11189 Org-mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
11190 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
11191 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
11192 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
11193 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
11194 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
11196 The following sections describe Org-mode's code block handling facilities.
11199 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
11200 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
11201 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
11202 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
11203 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
11204 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
11205 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
11206 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
11207 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
11208 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
11209 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
11210 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
11213 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11214 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
11216 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
11217 @section Structure of code blocks
11218 @cindex code block, structure
11219 @cindex source code, block structure
11221 The structure of code blocks is as follows:
11225 #+begin_src <language> <switches> <header arguments>
11230 Switches and header arguments are optional. Code can also be embedded in text
11234 src_<language>@{<body>@}
11240 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
11245 This name is associated with the code block. This is similar to the
11246 @samp{#+tblname} lines that can be used to name tables in Org-mode files.
11247 Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate the
11248 block from other places in the file, other files, or from Org-mode table
11249 formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}).
11251 The language of the code in the block.
11253 Optional switches controlling exportation of the code block (see switches discussion in
11254 @ref{Literal examples})
11255 @item <header arguments>
11256 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
11257 tangling of code blocks. See the @ref{Header arguments}
11258 section. Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
11259 basis using properties.
11264 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11265 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11267 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11268 @section Editing source code
11269 @cindex code block, editing
11270 @cindex source code, editing
11273 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
11274 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
11275 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
11276 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
11278 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
11279 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
11280 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
11281 further configuration options.
11284 @item org-src-lang-modes
11285 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
11286 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
11287 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
11288 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
11289 @item org-src-window-setup
11290 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
11291 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
11292 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
11293 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
11294 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
11295 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set
11296 this variable to nil to switch without asking.
11299 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
11300 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
11302 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11303 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11305 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11306 @section Exporting code blocks
11307 @cindex code block, exporting
11308 @cindex source code, exporting
11310 It is possible to export the @emph{contents} of code blocks, the
11311 @emph{results} of code block evaluation, @emph{neither}, or @emph{both}. For
11312 most languages, the default exports the contents of code blocks. However, for
11313 some languages (e.g.@: @code{ditaa}) the default exports the results of code
11314 block evaluation. For information on exporting code block bodies, see
11315 @ref{Literal examples}.
11317 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
11320 @subsubheading Header arguments:
11322 @item :exports code
11323 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
11324 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
11325 @item :exports results
11326 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
11327 Org-mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
11328 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
11329 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
11330 block will not be exported.
11331 @item :exports both
11332 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
11333 @item :exports none
11334 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
11337 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
11338 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
11339 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
11340 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org-mode files are
11341 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org-mode is used as the
11342 markup language for a wiki.
11344 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11345 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11346 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11347 @section Extracting source code
11349 @cindex source code, extracting
11350 @cindex code block, extracting source code
11352 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
11353 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
11354 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
11355 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
11356 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
11358 @subsubheading Header arguments
11361 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
11363 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
11364 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
11365 for the block language.
11366 @item :tangle filename
11367 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
11371 @subsubheading Functions
11373 @item org-babel-tangle
11374 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
11375 @item org-babel-tangle-file
11376 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
11379 @subsubheading Hooks
11381 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
11382 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
11383 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
11384 of tangled code files.
11387 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
11388 @section Evaluating code blocks
11389 @cindex code block, evaluating
11390 @cindex source code, evaluating
11392 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
11393 potential for that code to do harm. Org-mode provides a number of safeguards
11394 to ensure that it only evaluates code with explicit confirmation from the
11395 user. For information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see
11396 @ref{Code evaluation security}.} and the results placed in the Org-mode
11397 buffer. By default, evaluation is only turned on for @code{emacs-lisp} code
11398 blocks, however support exists for evaluating blocks in many languages. See
11399 @ref{Languages} for a list of supported languages. See @ref{Structure of
11400 code blocks} for information on the syntax used to define a code block.
11403 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
11404 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
11405 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
11406 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
11407 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
11408 its results into the Org-mode buffer.
11410 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an
11411 Org-mode buffer or an Org-mode table. @code{#+call} (or synonymously
11412 @code{#+function} or @code{#+lob}) lines can be used to remotely execute code
11413 blocks located in the current Org-mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel''
11414 (see @ref{Library of Babel}). These lines use the following syntax.
11417 #+call: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11418 #+function: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11419 #+lob: <name>(<arguments>) <header arguments>
11424 The name of the code block to be evaluated.
11426 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
11427 arguments should relate to @code{:var} header arguments in the called code
11428 block expressed using standard function call syntax. For example if the
11429 original code block named @code{double} has the header argument @code{:var
11430 n=2}, then the call line passing the number four to that block would be
11431 written as @code{#+call: double(n=2)}.
11432 @item <header arguments>
11433 Header arguments can be placed after the function invocation. See
11434 @ref{Header arguments} for more information on header arguments.
11437 All header arguments placed in the @code{<header arguments>} section
11438 described above will be applied to the evaluation of the @code{#+call:} line,
11439 however it is sometimes desirable to specify header arguments to be passed to
11440 the code block being evaluated.
11442 This is possible through the use of the following optional extended syntax.
11445 #+call: <name>[<block header arguments>](<arguments>) <header arguments>
11448 Any header argument placed between the square brackets in the @code{<block
11449 header arguments>} section will be applied to the evaluation of the named
11450 code block. For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+call:}
11451 lines see @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
11453 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
11454 @section Library of Babel
11455 @cindex babel, library of
11456 @cindex source code, library
11457 @cindex code block, library
11459 The ``Library of Babel'' is a library of code blocks
11460 that can be called from any Org-mode file. The library is housed in an
11461 Org-mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org-mode.
11462 Org-mode users can deposit functions they believe to be generally
11463 useful in the library.
11465 Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called remotely as if
11466 they were in the current Org-mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating code blocks}
11467 for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
11470 Code blocks located in any Org-mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
11471 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
11474 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
11476 @cindex babel, languages
11477 @cindex source code, languages
11478 @cindex code block, languages
11480 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
11482 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
11483 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
11484 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Emacs Calc @tab calc
11485 @item C @tab C @tab C++ @tab C++
11486 @item Clojure @tab clojure @tab CSS @tab css
11487 @item ditaa @tab ditaa @tab Graphviz @tab dot
11488 @item Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp @tab gnuplot @tab gnuplot
11489 @item Haskell @tab haskell @tab Javascript @tab js
11490 @item LaTeX @tab latex @tab Ledger @tab ledger
11491 @item Lisp @tab lisp @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
11492 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
11493 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org-mode @tab org
11494 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
11495 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
11496 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
11497 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
11498 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
11499 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
11502 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
11503 available, it can be found at
11504 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages}.
11506 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
11507 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
11508 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
11509 to your emacs configuration.
11512 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
11513 @code{R} code blocks.
11517 (org-babel-do-load-languages
11518 'org-babel-load-languages
11519 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
11523 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
11524 elisp file with @code{require}.
11527 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
11531 (require 'ob-clojure)
11534 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
11535 @section Header arguments
11536 @cindex code block, header arguments
11537 @cindex source code, block header arguments
11539 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
11540 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
11541 describes each header argument in detail.
11544 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
11545 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
11548 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
11549 @subsection Using header arguments
11551 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
11552 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
11554 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
11555 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
11556 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
11557 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
11558 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
11559 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
11563 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
11564 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
11565 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11566 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
11567 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
11571 :results => "replace"
11578 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
11580 @c ((:session . "none")
11581 @c (:results . "replace")
11582 @c (:exports . "code")
11584 @c (:noweb . "no"))
11588 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
11591 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
11592 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
11593 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
11597 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
11598 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
11599 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
11602 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11603 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
11604 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
11605 language-specific documentation available online at
11606 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
11608 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
11609 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
11610 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified through the use of a special
11611 line placed anywhere in an Org-mode file. The line consists of the
11612 @code{#+BABEL:} keyword followed by a series of header arguments which may be
11613 specified using the standard header argument syntax.
11615 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
11616 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
11617 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
11618 inserted into the buffer.
11621 #+BABEL: :session *R* :results silent
11624 @node Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
11625 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org-mode properties
11627 Header arguments are also read from Org-mode properties (see @ref{Property
11628 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
11629 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
11632 #+property: tangle yes
11635 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
11636 with inheritance, so the value of the @code{:cache} header argument will default
11637 to @code{yes} in all code blocks in the subtree rooted at the following
11648 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11649 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
11650 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
11651 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
11652 in Org-mode documents.
11654 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Using header arguments
11655 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
11657 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
11658 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
11659 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+begin_src} line.
11660 Properties set in this way override both the values of
11661 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
11662 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
11663 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
11664 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
11665 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
11666 preserved on export to HTML or LaTeX.
11669 #+source: factorial
11670 #+begin_src haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
11672 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
11675 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks:
11678 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
11681 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using =#+header:= or
11682 =#+headers:= lines preceding a code block or nested in between the name and
11683 body of a named code block.
11685 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
11687 #+headers: :var data1=1
11688 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data2=2
11689 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
11696 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
11698 #+source: named-block
11699 #+header: :var data=2
11700 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11701 (message "data:%S" data)
11704 #+results: named-block
11708 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
11709 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11710 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
11712 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
11713 function call lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
11714 information on the structure of @code{#+call:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
11717 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
11718 evaluation of the @code{#+call:} line.
11720 #+call: factorial(n=5) :exports results
11723 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
11724 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
11726 #+call: factorial[:session special](n=5)
11729 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
11730 @subsection Specific header arguments
11731 The following header arguments are defined:
11734 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
11735 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
11736 be collected and handled
11737 * file:: Specify a path for file output
11738 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
11739 directory for code block execution
11740 * exports:: Export code and/or results
11741 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
11742 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
11743 files during tangling
11744 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
11746 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
11747 expansion during tangling
11748 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
11749 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
11750 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
11751 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
11752 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
11753 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
11754 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
11755 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
11756 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
11759 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
11760 @subsubsection @code{:var}
11761 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
11762 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
11763 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
11764 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. The
11765 values passed to arguments can be literal values, values from org-mode tables
11766 and literal example blocks, or the results of other code blocks.
11768 These values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays---see the
11769 ``indexable variable values'' heading below.
11771 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
11772 @code{:var} header argument.
11778 where @code{assign} can take one of the following forms
11781 @item literal value
11782 either a string @code{"string"} or a number @code{9}.
11787 #+tblname: example-table
11793 #+source: table-length
11794 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
11798 #+results: table-length
11802 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+srcname:}, followed by
11806 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
11814 In addition, an argument can be passed to the code block referenced
11815 by @code{:var}. The argument is passed within the parentheses following the
11820 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=8
11828 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
11837 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
11838 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
11839 using the @code{#+source:} line of a code block. As in the following
11840 example arguments can be packed inside of parenthesis, separated by commas,
11841 following the source name.
11844 #+source: double(input=0, x=2)
11845 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11850 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
11851 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
11852 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
11853 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
11854 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. The
11855 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
11856 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
11859 #+results: example-table
11865 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
11873 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
11874 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
11875 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
11879 #+results: example-table
11886 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
11896 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
11897 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
11898 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
11899 column is referenced.
11902 #+results: example-table
11908 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
11916 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
11917 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
11918 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
11922 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
11923 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
11924 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
11925 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
11928 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
11936 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
11937 @subsubsection @code{:results}
11939 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
11940 per class may be supplied per code block.
11944 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
11945 from the code block
11947 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
11948 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
11951 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
11952 block should be handled.
11955 @subsubheading Collection
11956 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
11957 should be collected from the code block.
11961 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
11962 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
11963 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
11964 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
11965 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
11966 @item @code{output}
11967 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
11968 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
11969 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
11972 @subsubheading Type
11974 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
11975 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
11976 table or scalar depending on their value.
11979 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
11980 The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode table. If a single value is
11981 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
11982 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
11984 The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode list. If a single scalar
11985 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
11986 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
11987 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
11988 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org-mode
11989 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
11991 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
11992 into the Org-mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
11993 @item @code{raw}, @code{org}
11994 The results are interpreted as raw Org-mode code and are inserted directly
11995 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
11996 such by Org-mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
11998 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{begin_html}
11999 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
12001 Results assumed to be LaTeX and are enclosed in a @code{begin_latex} block.
12002 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
12004 Result are assumed to be parseable code and are enclosed in a code block.
12005 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
12007 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
12008 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
12009 @code{:results value pp}.
12012 @subsubheading Handling
12013 The following results options indicate what happens with the
12014 results once they are collected.
12017 @item @code{silent}
12018 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
12019 the Org-mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
12020 @item @code{replace}
12021 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
12022 will be inserted into the Org-mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
12023 @code{:results output replace}.
12024 @item @code{append}
12025 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
12026 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
12027 inserted as with @code{replace}.
12028 @item @code{prepend}
12029 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
12030 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
12031 inserted as with @code{replace}.
12034 @node file, dir, results, Specific header arguments
12035 @subsubsection @code{:file}
12037 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
12038 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org-mode style
12039 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
12040 into the Org-mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
12041 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
12042 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
12043 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
12044 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
12046 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
12047 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
12048 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
12050 @node dir, exports, file, Specific header arguments
12051 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
12053 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
12054 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
12055 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
12056 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
12057 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
12058 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
12059 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
12061 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
12062 (e.g.@: @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
12063 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
12065 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
12066 in your home directory, you could use
12069 #+begin_src R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
12070 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
12074 @subsubheading Remote execution
12075 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
12076 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
12079 #+begin_src R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
12080 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
12084 Text results will be returned to the local Org-mode buffer as usual, and file
12085 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
12086 relative to the remote directory. An Org-mode link to the remote file will be
12089 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
12090 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
12093 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
12096 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
12097 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
12098 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
12099 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
12101 @subsubheading Further points
12105 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
12106 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
12107 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
12109 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
12110 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
12111 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
12112 links inserted into the buffer will *not* be expanded against @code{default
12113 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
12114 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
12115 which the link does not point.
12118 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
12119 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
12121 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
12122 or LaTeX exports of the Org-mode file.
12126 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
12127 @code{:exports code}.
12128 @item @code{results}
12129 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
12130 @code{:exports results}.
12132 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
12133 @code{:exports both}.
12135 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
12138 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
12139 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
12141 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
12142 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
12145 @item @code{tangle}
12146 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the
12147 basename (name w/o extension) of the Org-mode file. E.g., @code{:tangle
12150 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
12151 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
12153 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
12154 as a file basename to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle
12158 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
12159 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
12161 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
12162 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
12163 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
12165 @node comments, no-expand, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
12166 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
12167 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
12168 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
12169 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
12170 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
12174 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
12176 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
12177 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
12179 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
12181 Include text from the org-mode file as a comment.
12183 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
12184 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
12186 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
12188 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
12189 references in the code block body in link comments.
12192 @node no-expand, session, comments, Specific header arguments
12193 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
12195 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
12196 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
12197 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
12198 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
12199 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
12201 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
12202 @subsubsection @code{:session}
12204 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
12205 language where state is preserved.
12207 By default, a session is not started.
12209 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
12210 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
12211 interpreted language.
12213 @node noweb, cache, session, Specific header arguments
12214 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
12216 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' style (see
12217 @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) references in a code block. This header
12218 argument can have one of three values: @code{yes} @code{no} or @code{tangle}.
12222 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
12223 expanded before the block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
12225 The default. No ``noweb'' syntax specific action is taken on evaluating
12226 code blocks, However, noweb references will still be expanded during
12228 @item @code{tangle}
12229 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
12230 expanded before the block is tangled, however ``noweb'' references will not
12231 be expanded when the block is evaluated or exported.
12234 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
12235 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
12236 @code{<<reference>>}.
12237 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
12238 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
12239 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
12252 -- multi-line body of example
12255 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
12256 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
12259 @node cache, sep, noweb, Specific header arguments
12260 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
12262 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
12263 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
12264 unchanged code blocks. This header argument can have one of two
12265 values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
12269 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
12270 every time it is called.
12272 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
12273 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
12274 @code{#+results:} line and will be checked on subsequent
12275 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
12276 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
12279 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
12280 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
12281 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
12282 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
12283 changed since it was last run.
12287 #+begin_src R :cache yes
12291 #+results[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
12295 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
12299 #+results[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
12303 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
12304 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
12306 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
12307 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org-mode. This is used
12308 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
12309 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
12310 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
12313 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
12316 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
12317 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
12319 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
12320 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
12321 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12325 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
12326 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
12327 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
12328 default value yields the following results.
12331 #+tblname: many-cols
12338 #+source: echo-table
12339 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols
12343 #+results: echo-table
12350 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
12353 #+tblname: many-cols
12360 #+source: echo-table
12361 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
12365 #+results: echo-table
12374 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
12375 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
12377 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
12378 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
12382 If an input table looks like it has column names
12383 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
12384 names will be removed from the table before
12385 processing, then reapplied to the results.
12388 #+tblname: less-cols
12394 #+srcname: echo-table-again
12395 #+begin_src python :var tab=less-cols
12396 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
12399 #+results: echo-table-again
12407 No column name pre-processing takes place
12410 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
12411 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e.@: the second row is not an
12415 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
12416 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
12418 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
12419 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12423 No row name pre-processing will take place.
12426 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
12427 and is then reapplied to the results.
12430 #+tblname: with-rownames
12431 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
12432 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
12434 #+srcname: echo-table-once-again
12435 #+begin_src python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
12436 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
12439 #+results: echo-table-once-again
12440 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
12441 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
12445 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
12446 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
12448 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
12449 (e.g.@: @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
12450 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
12451 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
12453 @node eval, , shebang, Specific header arguments
12454 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
12455 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
12456 specific code blocks. @code{:eval} accepts two arguments ``never'' and
12457 ``query''. @code{:eval never} will ensure that a code block is never
12458 evaluated, this can be useful for protecting against the evaluation of
12459 dangerous code blocks. @code{:eval query} will require a query for every
12460 execution of a code block regardless of the value of the
12461 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable.
12463 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
12464 @section Results of evaluation
12465 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
12466 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
12468 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
12469 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
12470 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
12471 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
12473 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
12474 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
12475 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
12476 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
12479 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
12480 non-session is returned to Org-mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
12481 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
12483 @subsection Non-session
12484 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12485 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
12486 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
12487 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
12488 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
12489 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
12490 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
12492 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
12493 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
12495 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12496 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
12497 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
12498 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
12501 @subsection Session
12502 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
12503 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12504 inferior process. The result returned is the result of the last evaluation
12505 performed by the interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific
12506 manner: the value of the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value
12507 of @code{.Last.value} in R).
12509 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
12510 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
12511 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
12512 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
12513 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
12514 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
12515 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
12518 #+begin_src python :results output
12529 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
12531 #+begin_src python :results output :session
12543 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
12544 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
12547 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
12548 @section Noweb reference syntax
12549 @cindex code block, noweb reference
12550 @cindex syntax, noweb
12551 @cindex source code, noweb reference
12553 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
12554 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
12555 familiar Noweb syntax:
12558 <<code-block-name>>
12561 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
12562 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
12563 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
12564 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
12565 expanded before evaluation.
12567 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
12568 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
12569 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
12570 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
12573 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
12574 @section Key bindings and useful functions
12575 @cindex code block, key bindings
12577 Many common Org-mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
12580 Within a code block, the following key bindings
12583 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12585 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
12587 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
12589 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
12591 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
12594 In an Org-mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
12596 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
12598 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
12599 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
12601 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
12602 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
12604 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
12605 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
12607 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-source-block}
12609 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
12611 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
12612 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
12614 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
12615 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
12617 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
12618 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
12620 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
12621 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
12623 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
12624 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
12627 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
12628 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
12630 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
12631 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
12632 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
12633 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
12634 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
12635 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
12636 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
12637 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
12638 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
12641 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
12642 @section Batch execution
12643 @cindex code block, batch execution
12644 @cindex source code, batch execution
12646 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
12647 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
12649 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
12653 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
12655 # tangle files with org-mode
12659 ORGINSTALL="~/src/org/lisp/org-install.el"
12661 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
12663 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
12666 emacs -Q --batch -l $ORGINSTALL \
12668 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
12669 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
12670 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
12671 (mapc (lambda (file)
12672 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
12674 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
12677 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
12678 @chapter Miscellaneous
12681 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
12682 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
12683 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
12684 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
12685 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
12686 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
12687 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
12688 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
12689 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
12690 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
12694 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
12695 @section Completion
12696 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
12697 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
12698 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
12699 @cindex completion, of option keywords
12700 @cindex completion, of tags
12701 @cindex completion, of property keys
12702 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
12703 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
12704 @cindex TODO keywords completion
12705 @cindex dictionary word completion
12706 @cindex option keyword completion
12707 @cindex tag completion
12708 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
12710 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org-mode uses it whenever it
12711 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
12712 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
12713 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
12714 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
12716 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
12717 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
12718 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
12721 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
12723 Complete word at point
12726 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
12728 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
12730 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
12731 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
12733 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
12734 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
12735 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
12736 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
12738 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
12739 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
12742 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
12744 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
12745 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org-mode. When the
12746 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
12747 will insert example settings for this keyword.
12749 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
12750 i.e.@: valid keys for this line.
12752 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
12756 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
12757 @section Easy Templates
12758 @cindex template insertion
12759 @cindex insertion, of templates
12761 Org-mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
12762 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
12763 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
12764 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
12765 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
12767 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
12768 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
12769 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
12771 The following template selectors are currently supported.
12773 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
12774 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+begin_src ... #+end_src}
12775 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+begin_example ... #+end_example}
12776 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+begin_quote ... #+end_quote}
12777 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+begin_verse ... #+end_verse}
12778 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+begin_center ... #+end_center}
12779 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+begin_latex ... #+end_latex}
12780 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+latex:}
12781 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+begin_html ... #+end_html}
12782 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+html:}
12783 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+begin_ascii ... #+end_ascii}
12784 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ascii:}
12785 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+include:} line
12788 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
12789 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
12791 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
12792 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
12793 additional details.
12795 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
12796 @section Speed keys
12798 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
12799 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
12801 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
12802 beginning of a headline, i.e.@: before the first star. Configure the variable
12803 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
12804 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
12805 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
12806 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
12807 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
12808 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
12810 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
12811 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
12813 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
12814 @section Code evaluation and security issues
12816 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
12818 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
12819 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
12820 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
12821 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
12822 these precautions intact.
12824 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
12825 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
12826 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
12828 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
12831 @item Source code blocks
12832 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
12833 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
12834 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
12835 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
12836 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
12838 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
12839 which take off the default security brakes.
12841 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
12842 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
12843 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
12844 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
12845 ask and nil not to ask.
12848 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
12851 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
12852 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
12853 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
12856 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
12857 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
12858 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
12861 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
12862 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
12864 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
12865 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
12868 @item Formulas in tables
12869 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
12870 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
12873 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
12874 @section Customization
12875 @cindex customization
12876 @cindex options, for customization
12877 @cindex variables, for customization
12879 There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
12880 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
12881 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
12882 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
12883 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
12884 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
12885 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
12887 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
12888 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
12889 @cindex in-buffer settings
12890 @cindex special keywords
12892 Org-mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
12893 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
12894 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
12895 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
12896 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
12897 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
12898 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
12899 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
12900 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
12902 @vindex org-archive-location
12904 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
12905 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
12906 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
12907 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12908 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
12910 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
12911 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
12912 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
12913 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
12914 @cindex property, COLUMNS
12915 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
12916 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
12918 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
12919 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
12920 @vindex org-table-formula
12921 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
12922 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
12923 The global version of this variable is
12924 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
12925 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
12926 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
12928 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
12929 @vindex org-drawers
12930 Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
12931 @code{org-drawers}.
12932 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
12933 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
12934 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
12935 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
12936 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
12937 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
12938 @vindex org-highest-priority
12939 @vindex org-lowest-priority
12940 @vindex org-default-priority
12941 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
12942 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
12943 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
12944 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
12945 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
12946 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
12947 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
12948 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
12949 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
12950 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
12951 (i.e.@: when starting Org-mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
12952 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
12953 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
12954 any other Org-mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
12955 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
12958 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org-mode, when an
12959 Org file is being visited.
12961 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
12962 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
12963 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
12965 @vindex org-startup-folded
12966 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
12967 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
12968 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
12969 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
12971 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
12972 content @r{all headlines}
12973 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
12974 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
12977 @vindex org-startup-indented
12978 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
12979 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
12980 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
12981 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org-mode 6.29 are required}
12983 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
12984 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
12987 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
12988 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
12989 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
12990 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
12992 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
12993 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
12995 align @r{align all tables}
12996 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
12999 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
13000 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
13001 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
13002 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
13003 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
13004 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
13006 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
13007 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
13010 @vindex org-log-done
13011 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
13012 @vindex org-log-repeat
13013 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
13014 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
13015 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
13016 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
13017 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
13018 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
13019 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
13020 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
13021 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
13022 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
13023 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
13024 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
13025 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
13026 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
13027 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
13028 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
13029 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
13030 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
13031 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
13032 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
13034 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
13035 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
13036 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
13037 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
13038 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
13039 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
13040 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
13041 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
13042 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
13043 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
13044 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
13045 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
13046 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
13047 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
13048 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
13049 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
13050 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
13052 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
13053 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
13054 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
13055 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
13056 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
13057 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
13058 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
13059 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
13060 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
13061 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
13063 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
13064 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
13065 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
13066 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
13067 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
13068 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
13070 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
13071 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
13072 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
13073 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
13074 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
13075 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
13077 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
13079 @vindex constants-unit-system
13080 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
13081 @code{constants-unit-system}).
13082 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
13083 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
13085 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
13086 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
13088 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
13089 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
13090 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
13091 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
13092 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
13093 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
13094 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
13095 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
13096 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
13097 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
13098 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
13099 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
13100 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
13101 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
13102 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
13104 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
13105 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
13106 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
13107 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
13108 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
13109 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
13110 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
13111 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
13112 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
13114 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
13115 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
13116 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
13117 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
13118 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
13120 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
13121 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
13123 @cindex org-pretty-entities
13124 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
13125 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
13126 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
13127 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
13129 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
13130 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
13132 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
13133 @vindex org-tag-alist
13134 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
13135 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
13136 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
13138 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
13139 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
13140 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
13141 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
13142 @itemx #+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
13143 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
13144 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
13145 @ref{Export options}.
13146 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
13147 @vindex org-todo-keywords
13148 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
13149 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
13152 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
13153 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
13155 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
13157 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
13158 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
13159 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
13160 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
13161 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
13162 what this means in different contexts.
13166 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
13167 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
13169 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
13170 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
13173 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
13174 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
13176 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
13179 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
13180 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
13183 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
13184 corresponding links in this buffer.
13186 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
13187 drawer, offer property commands.
13189 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
13190 definition, and vice versa.
13192 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
13194 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
13197 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
13200 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
13204 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
13205 @section A cleaner outline view
13206 @cindex hiding leading stars
13207 @cindex dynamic indentation
13208 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
13209 @cindex clean outline view
13211 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
13212 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
13213 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
13214 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
13215 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
13219 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
13220 ** Second level | * Second level
13221 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
13222 some text | some text
13223 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
13224 more text | more text
13225 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
13231 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
13232 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
13233 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
13234 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
13235 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
13236 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
13237 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
13238 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
13239 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
13240 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
13241 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
13242 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
13243 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
13244 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
13245 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
13246 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
13247 individual files using
13253 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
13254 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
13255 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
13260 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
13261 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
13262 with the headline, like
13266 more text, now indented
13269 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
13270 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
13271 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
13272 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
13275 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
13276 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
13277 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
13278 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
13282 #+STARTUP: hidestars
13283 #+STARTUP: showstars
13286 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
13290 * Top level headline
13298 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
13299 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
13300 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
13301 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
13302 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
13303 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
13304 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
13307 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
13308 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
13309 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
13310 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
13311 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
13312 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
13313 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
13314 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
13315 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
13322 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
13323 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
13324 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
13325 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
13328 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
13329 @section Using Org on a tty
13330 @cindex tty key bindings
13332 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
13333 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
13334 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
13335 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
13336 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
13337 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
13338 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
13339 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
13340 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
13341 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
13342 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
13344 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
13345 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
13346 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
13347 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
13348 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
13349 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
13350 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
13351 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
13352 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
13353 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
13354 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
13355 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13356 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
13357 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13358 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13359 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13360 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13361 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13362 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13363 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13367 @node Interaction, , TTY keys, Miscellaneous
13368 @section Interaction with other packages
13369 @cindex packages, interaction with other
13370 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
13371 with other code out there.
13374 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
13375 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
13378 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
13379 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
13382 @cindex @file{calc.el}
13383 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
13384 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
13385 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
13386 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
13387 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
13388 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
13389 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
13390 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
13391 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
13392 , Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
13393 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
13394 @cindex @file{constants.el}
13395 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
13396 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
13397 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
13398 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
13399 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
13400 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
13401 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
13402 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
13403 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
13404 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
13405 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
13406 @file{constants.el}.
13407 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
13408 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
13409 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
13410 Org-mode can make use of the CDLa@TeX{} package to efficiently enter
13411 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
13412 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
13413 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
13414 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org-mode
13415 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
13417 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13418 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
13420 @vindex org-imenu-depth
13421 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
13422 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
13423 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
13424 @cindex @file{remember.el}
13425 @cindex Wiegley, John
13426 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
13427 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
13428 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
13429 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
13430 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
13431 index items in files. Org-mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
13432 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
13433 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
13434 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
13435 @cindex @file{table.el}
13436 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
13438 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
13439 @cindex @file{table.el}
13440 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
13442 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
13443 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
13444 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
13445 Org-mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
13446 interference with other Org-mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
13447 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
13448 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
13451 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
13452 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
13454 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
13455 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
13456 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org-mode
13457 format. See the documentation string of the command
13458 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
13461 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
13462 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
13463 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
13464 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
13465 Org-mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
13466 However, Org-mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
13467 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
13470 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
13471 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org-mode
13475 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
13476 @vindex org-support-shift-select
13477 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
13478 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
13479 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
13480 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
13481 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
13482 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
13483 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org-mode then tries to accommodate shift
13484 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
13485 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
13486 cursor moves across a special context.
13488 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
13489 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
13490 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
13491 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
13492 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
13493 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
13494 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
13495 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
13496 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
13497 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
13498 Org-mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
13499 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
13500 buffer (but not during date selection).
13503 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
13504 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
13505 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
13508 @vindex org-disputed-keys
13509 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
13510 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
13511 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
13513 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
13514 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
13515 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
13516 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
13517 fixed this problem:
13520 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13522 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
13523 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-group)))
13526 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
13527 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
13531 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
13532 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
13535 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
13538 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13540 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
13541 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
13542 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
13543 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
13546 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
13547 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
13548 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
13549 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
13550 the windmove function active in locations where Org-mode does not have
13551 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
13555 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
13556 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
13557 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
13558 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
13559 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
13562 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
13563 @cindex @file{viper.el}
13565 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
13566 corresponding Org-mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
13567 another key for this command, or override the key in
13568 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
13571 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
13577 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
13581 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
13585 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
13586 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
13587 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
13588 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
13589 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
13590 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
13591 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
13592 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
13593 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
13594 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
13597 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
13601 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
13602 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
13603 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
13604 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
13605 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
13607 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
13608 @section Add-on packages
13609 @cindex add-on packages
13611 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
13612 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
13613 packages with the separate release available at the Org-mode home page at
13614 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
13615 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
13616 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
13620 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
13621 @section Adding hyperlink types
13622 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
13624 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
13625 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
13626 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
13627 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
13628 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
13632 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
13636 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
13637 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
13639 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
13640 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
13642 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
13644 (defun org-man-open (path)
13645 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
13646 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
13647 (funcall org-man-command path))
13649 (defun org-man-store-link ()
13650 "Store a link to a manpage."
13651 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
13652 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
13653 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
13654 (link (concat "man:" page))
13655 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
13656 (org-store-link-props
13659 :description description))))
13661 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
13662 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
13663 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
13664 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
13665 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
13666 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
13670 ;;; org-man.el ends here
13674 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
13681 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
13684 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
13687 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
13688 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
13689 that will be called to follow such a link.
13691 @vindex org-store-link-functions
13692 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
13693 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
13694 buffer displaying a man page.
13697 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
13698 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
13699 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
13700 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
13701 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
13702 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
13703 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
13705 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
13706 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
13707 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
13708 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
13709 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
13710 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
13711 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
13712 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
13713 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
13714 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
13715 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
13716 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
13718 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
13719 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
13720 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
13721 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
13723 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
13724 @section Context-sensitive commands
13725 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
13726 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
13727 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
13729 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
13730 important example it the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
13731 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
13733 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
13734 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
13735 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
13736 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
13737 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the org-mode functionality
13738 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
13739 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
13743 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
13744 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
13745 (if (save-excursion
13746 (beginning-of-line 1)
13747 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
13748 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
13749 t) ;; to signal that we took action
13750 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
13752 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
13755 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
13756 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
13757 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
13758 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
13761 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
13762 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
13763 @cindex tables, in other modes
13764 @cindex lists, in other modes
13765 @cindex Orgtbl mode
13767 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
13768 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
13769 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
13770 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
13771 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl-mode table
13774 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
13775 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
13776 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
13777 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
13778 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
13779 for a very flexible system.
13781 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
13782 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
13783 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
13784 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
13788 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
13789 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
13790 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
13791 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
13794 @node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13795 @subsection Radio tables
13796 @cindex radio tables
13798 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
13799 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
13800 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
13801 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
13804 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13805 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
13809 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
13810 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
13814 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
13818 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
13819 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
13820 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
13821 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
13822 passed as a property list to the translation function for
13823 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
13824 acted upon before the translation function is called:
13828 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
13831 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
13832 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
13833 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
13834 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
13835 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
13836 additional columns.
13840 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
13841 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
13842 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
13843 number of different solutions:
13847 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
13848 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
13849 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
13851 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
13852 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
13855 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
13856 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
13857 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
13858 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
13862 @node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13863 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
13864 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
13866 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
13867 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
13868 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
13869 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
13870 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
13871 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
13872 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
13873 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
13874 will then get the following template:
13876 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
13878 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13879 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13881 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13887 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
13888 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
13889 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
13890 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
13891 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
13892 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
13893 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
13894 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
13895 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
13896 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
13897 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
13898 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
13901 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13902 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13904 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
13905 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13906 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13907 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13908 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13909 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13910 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13911 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
13916 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
13917 table inserted between the two marker lines.
13919 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
13920 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
13921 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
13922 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e.@: to not produce
13923 header and footer commands of the target table:
13926 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
13927 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
13928 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13929 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
13933 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
13934 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
13935 |-------+------+---------+---------|
13936 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
13937 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
13938 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
13939 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
13943 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
13944 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
13945 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
13946 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
13949 @item :splice nil/t
13950 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
13951 tabular environment. Default is nil.
13954 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
13955 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
13956 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
13957 column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
13958 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
13959 function must return a formatted string.
13962 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
13963 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
13964 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
13965 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
13966 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
13967 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
13968 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
13969 supplied instead of strings.
13972 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
13973 @subsection Translator functions
13974 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
13975 @cindex translator function
13977 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
13978 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
13979 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
13980 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
13981 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
13982 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
13983 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
13984 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
13985 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
13989 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
13990 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
13991 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
13992 org-table-last-alignment ""))
13995 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
13996 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
13997 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
13998 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
13999 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
14003 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
14004 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
14005 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e.@: the
14006 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
14007 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
14008 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
14009 overrule the default with
14012 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
14015 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
14016 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
14017 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
14018 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
14019 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
14020 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
14024 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
14025 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
14029 Please check the documentation string of the function
14030 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
14031 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
14032 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
14033 using the generic function.
14035 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
14036 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
14037 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
14038 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
14039 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
14040 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
14041 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
14042 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
14043 others can benefit from your work.
14045 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
14046 @subsection Radio lists
14047 @cindex radio lists
14048 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
14050 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
14051 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
14052 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
14053 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
14055 Here are the differences with radio tables:
14059 Orgstruct mode must be active.
14061 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
14063 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
14066 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
14069 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
14074 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
14075 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
14077 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
14086 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
14087 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
14089 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
14090 @section Dynamic blocks
14091 @cindex dynamic blocks
14093 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
14094 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
14095 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
14096 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
14098 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
14099 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
14100 the content of the block.
14102 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
14104 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
14109 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
14112 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
14113 Update dynamic block at point.
14114 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
14115 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
14118 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
14119 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
14120 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
14121 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
14122 extra parameter @code{:content}.
14124 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
14125 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
14126 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
14127 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
14131 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
14137 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
14140 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
14141 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
14142 (insert "Last block update at: "
14143 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
14146 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
14147 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
14148 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
14149 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
14152 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
14153 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
14155 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
14156 @section Special agenda views
14157 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
14159 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
14160 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
14161 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
14162 made by these agenda views: @code{todo}, @code{alltodo}, @code{tags},
14163 @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function that is used
14164 at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of the agenda
14165 view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a global
14166 condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition would be
14167 stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
14168 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
14169 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
14171 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
14172 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
14173 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
14174 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
14175 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
14176 the subtree belonging to the project line.
14178 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
14179 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
14180 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
14181 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
14182 search should continue from there.
14185 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
14186 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
14187 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
14188 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
14189 nil ; tag found, do not skip
14190 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
14193 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
14197 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
14198 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
14199 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
14200 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
14203 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
14204 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
14205 meaningful header in the agenda view.
14207 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14208 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
14209 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
14210 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
14211 your custom search function, simply do a search for
14212 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
14213 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
14214 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
14215 you really want to have.
14217 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
14218 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
14219 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
14222 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
14223 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
14224 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
14225 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
14226 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
14227 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
14228 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
14229 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
14230 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
14231 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
14232 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
14233 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
14234 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
14235 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
14236 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
14237 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
14238 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
14239 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
14240 @item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
14241 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
14244 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
14245 like this, even without defining a special function:
14248 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
14249 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
14250 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
14251 'regexp ":waiting:"))
14252 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
14255 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
14256 @section Extracting agenda information
14257 @cindex agenda, pipe
14258 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
14260 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
14261 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
14262 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
14263 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
14264 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
14265 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
14266 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
14267 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
14268 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
14269 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
14270 current TODO list, you could use
14273 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
14276 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
14277 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
14278 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
14279 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
14282 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
14283 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
14287 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
14290 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
14291 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
14292 org-agenda-span month \
14293 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
14294 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
14299 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
14300 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
14302 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
14303 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
14304 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
14305 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
14309 category @r{The category of the item}
14310 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
14311 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
14312 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
14313 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
14314 diary @r{imported from diary}
14315 deadline @r{a deadline}
14316 scheduled @r{scheduled}
14317 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
14318 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
14319 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
14320 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
14321 block @r{entry has date block including date}
14322 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
14323 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
14324 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
14325 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
14326 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
14327 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
14328 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
14332 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
14333 led to the selection of the item.
14335 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
14336 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
14337 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
14342 # define the Emacs command to run
14343 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
14345 # run it and capture the output
14346 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
14348 # loop over all lines
14349 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
14350 # get the individual values
14351 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
14352 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
14353 # process and print
14354 print "[ ] $head\n";
14358 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
14359 @section Using the property API
14360 @cindex API, for properties
14361 @cindex properties, API
14363 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
14366 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
14367 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
14368 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
14369 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
14370 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
14371 if the property key was used several times.@*
14372 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
14373 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
14374 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
14376 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
14377 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
14378 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
14379 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
14380 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
14381 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
14382 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
14383 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
14386 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
14387 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
14390 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
14391 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
14394 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
14395 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
14398 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
14399 Insert a property drawer at point.
14402 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
14403 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
14404 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
14407 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
14408 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14409 values and return the values as a list of strings.
14412 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
14413 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14414 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
14417 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
14418 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14419 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
14422 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
14423 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14424 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
14427 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
14428 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
14429 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
14430 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
14431 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
14432 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
14433 responsible for this property.
14436 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
14437 @section Using the mapping API
14438 @cindex API, for mapping
14439 @cindex mapping entries, API
14441 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
14442 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
14443 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
14444 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
14447 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
14448 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
14450 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
14451 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
14452 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
14453 returned as a list.
14455 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
14456 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
14457 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
14458 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
14459 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
14460 if you have removed (e.g.@: archived) the current (sub)tree it could
14461 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
14462 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
14463 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
14466 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
14467 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
14468 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
14469 visited by the iteration.
14471 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
14474 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
14475 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
14476 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
14478 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
14479 agenda @r{all agenda files}
14480 agenda-with-archives
14481 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
14483 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
14486 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
14487 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
14489 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
14491 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
14492 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
14493 function or Lisp form
14494 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
14495 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
14496 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
14497 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
14501 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
14502 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
14503 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
14504 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
14506 @defun org-todo &optional arg
14507 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
14508 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
14511 @defun org-priority &optional action
14512 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
14513 possible values for ACTION.
14516 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
14517 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
14518 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
14522 Promote the current entry.
14526 Demote the current entry.
14529 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
14530 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
14531 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
14535 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
14536 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
14539 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
14540 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
14543 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
14546 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
14547 @appendix MobileOrg
14551 @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, MobileOrg} is an application for the
14552 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch} series of devices, developed by Richard Moreland.
14553 @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and capture support for an Org-mode
14554 system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It does also allow you to record
14555 changes to existing entries. Android users should check out
14556 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
14559 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
14560 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
14561 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
14563 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
14564 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
14565 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
14566 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
14567 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
14568 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
14569 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
14572 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
14573 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
14574 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
14577 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14578 @section Setting up the staging area
14580 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
14581 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
14582 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org-mode 7.02 and with
14583 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
14584 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
14585 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
14586 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
14587 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
14588 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
14589 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
14590 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
14592 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
14593 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
14594 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
14595 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
14596 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
14597 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
14598 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
14602 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
14605 Org-mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
14606 and to read captured notes from there.
14608 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
14609 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
14611 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
14612 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
14613 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
14614 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobiles-files}. File names will be
14615 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
14616 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
14617 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
14618 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org-mode will force ID properties
14619 on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
14620 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
14621 these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
14622 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
14623 rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
14624 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
14625 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
14626 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
14627 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically
14628 in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
14630 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
14631 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
14633 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
14634 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
14635 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
14636 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
14637 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
14641 Org moves all entries found in
14642 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
14643 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
14644 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
14645 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
14647 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
14648 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
14649 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
14650 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
14651 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
14652 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
14653 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
14654 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
14656 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
14657 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
14658 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
14659 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
14664 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
14665 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
14666 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
14667 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
14668 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
14669 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
14670 this flagged entry is finished.
14675 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
14676 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
14677 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
14678 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
14679 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
14680 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
14681 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
14683 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
14684 @appendix History and acknowledgments
14685 @cindex acknowledgments
14689 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
14690 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
14691 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
14692 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
14693 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
14694 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
14695 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
14696 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
14697 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
14698 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
14699 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
14700 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
14701 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
14702 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
14703 functionality directly into a notes file.
14705 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
14706 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
14707 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
14708 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
14709 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
14710 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
14711 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
14714 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
14717 @item Bastien Guerry
14718 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
14719 integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX exporter and the plain
14720 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
14721 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
14722 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsors
14723 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
14724 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
14725 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
14726 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
14727 programming and reproducible research.
14729 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
14730 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
14731 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
14732 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
14733 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
14734 of his great @file{remember.el}.
14735 @item Sebastian Rose
14736 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
14737 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
14738 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
14739 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
14740 single-key navigation.
14743 @noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
14744 know what I am missing here!
14749 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
14751 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
14753 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
14756 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
14758 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
14760 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org-mode files.
14762 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
14764 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
14765 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
14767 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
14770 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
14771 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
14772 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
14774 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
14776 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
14778 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
14779 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
14782 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
14784 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
14785 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
14786 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
14788 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
14789 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
14791 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
14792 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
14793 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
14795 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
14798 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
14800 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
14802 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
14803 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
14805 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
14807 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
14809 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
14811 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
14814 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
14815 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
14817 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
14819 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
14821 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
14823 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
14826 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
14827 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
14828 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
14830 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
14833 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
14835 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
14836 folded entries, and column view for properties.
14838 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
14840 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
14842 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
14843 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
14845 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
14846 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
14848 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
14849 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
14850 small fixes and patches.
14852 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
14854 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
14856 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
14859 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
14862 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
14864 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
14865 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
14867 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
14869 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
14871 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
14872 file links, and TAGS.
14874 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
14875 version of the reference card.
14877 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
14880 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
14882 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
14883 links, among other things.
14885 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
14886 provided frequent feedback.
14888 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
14889 into bundles of 20 for undo.
14891 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
14893 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
14896 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
14897 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
14899 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
14901 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
14902 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
14904 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
14907 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
14908 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
14910 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
14913 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
14915 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
14916 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
14918 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
14919 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
14921 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
14922 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
14924 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
14927 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
14929 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
14930 tweaks and features.
14932 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
14933 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
14935 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
14936 LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
14938 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
14939 with links transformation to Org syntax.
14941 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
14942 chapter about publishing.
14944 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with LaTeX and BEAMER export and
14945 enabled source code highlighling in Gnus.
14947 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
14948 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
14949 concept index for HTML export.
14951 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
14954 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
14956 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
14959 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
14962 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
14965 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
14968 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
14969 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
14973 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
14974 @unnumbered Concept index
14978 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
14979 @unnumbered Key index
14983 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
14984 @unnumbered Command and function index
14988 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
14989 @unnumbered Variable index
14991 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
14992 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
14993 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
15000 arch-tag: 7893d1Fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1CBC7ac
15003 @c Local variables:
15005 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
15006 @c paragraph-start: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
15007 @c paragraph-separate: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
15011 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre